commit
						7cabe81373
					
				@ -1,1503 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings such as:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of electronics
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of temperature sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Printer geometry
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Endstop configuration
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LCD controller
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Extra features
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings can be found in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Getting Started =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Here are some standard links for getting your machine calibrated:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Calibration
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://youtu.be/wAL9d7FgInk
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://calculator.josefprusa.cz
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Triffid_Hunter%27s_Calibration_Guide
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:5573
 | 
				
			||||
 * https://sites.google.com/site/repraplogphase/calibration-of-your-reprap
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:298812
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= DELTA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Delta printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/delta directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= SCARA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Scara printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/SCARA directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section info
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// User-specified version info of this build to display in [Pronterface, etc] terminal window during
 | 
				
			||||
// startup. Implementation of an idea by Prof Braino to inform user that any changes made to this
 | 
				
			||||
// build by the user have been successfully uploaded into firmware.
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_CONFIG_H_AUTHOR "(none, default config)" // Who made the changes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define CUSTOM_MACHINE_NAME "UBL5.0 FT2020"
 | 
				
			||||
#define SHOW_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE1 SHORT_BUILD_VERSION // will be shown during bootup in line 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE2 WEBSITE_URL         // will be shown during bootup in line 2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// *** VENDORS PLEASE READ *****************************************************
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin now allow you to have a vendor boot image to be displayed on machine
 | 
				
			||||
// start. When SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN is defined Marlin will first show your
 | 
				
			||||
// custom boot image and then the default Marlin boot image is shown.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// We suggest for you to take advantage of this new feature and keep the Marlin
 | 
				
			||||
// boot image unmodified. For an example have a look at the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
// example configuration folder.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select which serial port on the board will be used for communication with the host.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This allows the connection of wireless adapters (for instance) to non-default port pins.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Serial port 0 is always used by the Arduino bootloader regardless of this setting.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERIAL_PORT 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * This setting determines the communication speed of the printer.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 250000 works in most cases, but you might try a lower speed if
 | 
				
			||||
 * you commonly experience drop-outs during host printing.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[2400, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200, 250000]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define BAUDRATE 250000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable the Bluetooth serial interface on AT90USB devices
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLUETOOTH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The following define selects which electronics board you have.
 | 
				
			||||
// Please choose the name from boards.h that matches your setup
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef MOTHERBOARD
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MOTHERBOARD BOARD_RAMPS_14_EFB
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Optional custom name for your RepStrap or other custom machine
 | 
				
			||||
// Displayed in the LCD "Ready" message
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CUSTOM_MACHINE_NAME "3D Printer"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define this to set a unique identifier for this printer, (Used by some programs to differentiate between machines)
 | 
				
			||||
// You can use an online service to generate a random UUID. (eg http://www.uuidgenerator.net/version4)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MACHINE_UUID "00000000-0000-0000-0000-000000000000"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the number of extruders
 | 
				
			||||
// :[1, 2, 3, 4]
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDERS 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if your E steppers or extruder gear ratios are not identical
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISTINCT_E_FACTORS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Cyclops or any "multi-extruder" that shares a single nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SINGLENOZZLE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual extruder that uses a single stepper motor
 | 
				
			||||
// Don't forget to set SSDE_SERVO_ANGLES and HOTEND_OFFSET_X/Y/Z
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SWITCHING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_ANGLES { 0, 90 } // Angles for E0, E1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Z {0.0, 0.0}
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Mixing Extruder"
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Adds a new code, M165, to set the current mix factors.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Extends the stepping routines to move multiple steppers in proportion to the mix.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Optional support for Repetier Host M163, M164, and virtual extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - This implementation supports only a single extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Enable DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1 for Pia Taubert's reference implementation
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MIXING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MIXING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_STEPPERS 2        // Number of steppers in your mixing extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_VIRTUAL_TOOLS 16  // Use the Virtual Tool method with M163 and M164
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1    // Allow ABCDHI mix factors in G1 movement commands
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Offset of the extruders (uncomment if using more than one and relying on firmware to position when changing).
 | 
				
			||||
// The offset has to be X=0, Y=0 for the extruder 0 hotend (default extruder).
 | 
				
			||||
// For the other hotends it is their distance from the extruder 0 hotend.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_X {0.0, 20.00} // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the X axis
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Y {0.0, 5.00}  // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the Y axis
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select your power supply here. Use 0 if you haven't connected the PS_ON_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 0 = No Power Switch
 | 
				
			||||
 * 1 = ATX
 | 
				
			||||
 * 2 = X-Box 360 203Watts (the blue wire connected to PS_ON and the red wire to VCC)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ 0:'No power switch', 1:'ATX', 2:'X-Box 360' }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define POWER_SUPPLY 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if POWER_SUPPLY > 0
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option to leave the PSU off at startup.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Power to steppers and heaters will need to be turned on with M80.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PS_DEFAULT_OFF
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Thermal Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * --NORMAL IS 4.7kohm PULLUP!-- 1kohm pullup can be used on hotend sensor, using correct resistor and table
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Temperature sensors available:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -3 : thermocouple with MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -2 : thermocouple with MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -1 : thermocouple with AD595
 | 
				
			||||
 *     0 : not used
 | 
				
			||||
 *     1 : 100k thermistor - best choice for EPCOS 100k (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     2 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     3 : Mendel-parts thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     4 : 10k thermistor !! do not use it for a hotend. It gives bad resolution at high temp. !!
 | 
				
			||||
 *     5 : 100K thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     6 : 100k EPCOS - Not as accurate as table 1 (created using a fluke thermocouple) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     7 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAG-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    71 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAF-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     8 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     9 : 100k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    10 : 100k RS thermistor 198-961 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    11 : 100k beta 3950 1% thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    12 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup) (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    13 : 100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend "Simple ONE " & "Hotend "All In ONE"
 | 
				
			||||
 *    20 : the PT100 circuit found in the Ultimainboard V2.x
 | 
				
			||||
 *    60 : 100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950
 | 
				
			||||
 *    66 : 4.7M High Temperature thermistor from Dyze Design
 | 
				
			||||
 *    70 : the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
 *    75 : 100k Generic Silicon Heat Pad with NTC 100K MGB18-104F39050L32 thermistor
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *       1k ohm pullup tables - This is atypical, and requires changing out the 4.7k pullup for 1k.
 | 
				
			||||
 *                              (but gives greater accuracy and more stable PID)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    51 : 100k thermistor - EPCOS (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    52 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    55 : 100k thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1047 : Pt1000 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1010 : Pt1000 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   147 : Pt100 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *   110 : Pt100 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *         Use these for Testing or Development purposes. NEVER for production machine.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   998 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 25°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   999 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 100°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ '0': "Not used", '1':"100k / 4.7k - EPCOS", '2':"200k / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '3':"Mendel-parts / 4.7k", '4':"10k !! do not use for a hotend. Bad resolution at high temp. !!", '5':"100K / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '6':"100k / 4.7k EPCOS - Not as accurate as Table 1", '7':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAG-J01", '8':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT", '9':"100k / 4.7k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1", '10':"100k / 4.7k RS 198-961", '11':"100k / 4.7k beta 3950 1%", '12':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)", '13':"100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend 'Simple ONE ' & hotend 'All In ONE'", '20':"PT100 (Ultimainboard V2.x)", '51':"100k / 1k - EPCOS", '52':"200k / 1k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '55':"100k / 1k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '60':"100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950", '66':"Dyze Design 4.7M High Temperature thermistor", '70':"the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2", '71':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAF-J01", '147':"Pt100 / 4.7k", '1047':"Pt1000 / 4.7k", '110':"Pt100 / 1k (non-standard)", '1010':"Pt1000 / 1k (non standard)", '-3':"Thermocouple + MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)", '-2':"Thermocouple + MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)", '-1':"Thermocouple + AD595",'998':"Dummy 1", '999':"Dummy 2" }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_0 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_1 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_2 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_3 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_BED 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dummy thermistor constant temperature readings, for use with 998 and 999
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_998_VALUE 25
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_999_VALUE 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use temp sensor 1 as a redundant sensor with sensor 0. If the readings
 | 
				
			||||
// from the two sensors differ too much the print will be aborted.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_SENSOR_1_AS_REDUNDANT
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_REDUNDANT_TEMP_SENSOR_DIFF 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder temperature must be close to target for this long before M109 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bed temperature must be close to target for this long before M190 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimal temperature defines the temperature below which the heater will not be enabled It is used
 | 
				
			||||
// to check that the wiring to the thermistor is not broken.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise this would lead to the heater being powered on all the time.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When temperature exceeds max temp, your heater will be switched off.
 | 
				
			||||
// This feature exists to protect your hotend from overheating accidentally, but *NOT* from thermistor short/failure!
 | 
				
			||||
// You should use MINTEMP for thermistor short/failure protection.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MAXTEMP 245
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MAXTEMP 245
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MAXTEMP 245
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MAXTEMP 245
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MAXTEMP 115
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID Settings ================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// PID Tuning Guide here: http://reprap.org/wiki/PID_Tuning
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Comment the following line to disable PID and enable bang-bang.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#define BANG_MAX 255 // limits current to nozzle while in bang-bang mode; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#define PID_MAX BANG_MAX // limits current to nozzle while PID is active (see PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE below); 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_AUTOTUNE_MENU // Add PID Autotune to the LCD "Temperature" menu to run M303 and apply the result.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_OPENLOOP 1 // Puts PID in open loop. M104/M140 sets the output power from 0 to PID_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SLOW_PWM_HEATERS // PWM with very low frequency (roughly 0.125Hz=8s) and minimum state time of approximately 1s useful for heaters driven by a relay
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_PARAMS_PER_HOTEND // Uses separate PID parameters for each extruder (useful for mismatched extruders)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Set/get with gcode: M301 E[extruder number, 0-2]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE 10 // If the temperature difference between the target temperature and the actual temperature
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // is more than PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE then the PID will be shut off and the heater will be set to min/max.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define K1 0.95 //smoothing factor within the PID
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you are using a pre-configured hotend then you can use one of the value sets by uncommenting it
 | 
				
			||||
  // Ultimaker
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kp 11.50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Ki 0.50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kd 60.00
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // MakerGear
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 7.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 0.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Mendel Parts V9 on 12V
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 63.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 2.25
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 440
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID > Bed Temperature Control ===============
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// Select PID or bang-bang with PIDTEMPBED. If bang-bang, BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING will enable hysteresis
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this to enable PID on the bed. It uses the same frequency PWM as the extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your PID_dT is the default, and correct for your hardware/configuration, that means 7.689Hz,
 | 
				
			||||
// which is fine for driving a square wave into a resistive load and does not significantly impact you FET heating.
 | 
				
			||||
// This also works fine on a Fotek SSR-10DA Solid State Relay into a 250W heater.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your configuration is significantly different than this and you don't understand the issues involved, you probably
 | 
				
			||||
// shouldn't use bed PID until someone else verifies your hardware works.
 | 
				
			||||
// If this is enabled, find your own PID constants below.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This sets the max power delivered to the bed, and replaces the HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER option.
 | 
				
			||||
// all forms of bed control obey this (PID, bang-bang, bang-bang with hysteresis)
 | 
				
			||||
// setting this to anything other than 255 enables a form of PWM to the bed just like HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER did,
 | 
				
			||||
// so you shouldn't use it unless you are OK with PWM on your bed.  (see the comment on enabling PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_BED_POWER 255 // limits duty cycle to bed; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_BED_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from FOPDT model - kp=.39 Tp=405 Tdead=66, Tc set to 79.2, aggressive factor of .15 (vs .1, 1, 10)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKp 250.0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKi 18.0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKd 950.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from pidautotune
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKp 97.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKi 1.41
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKd 1675.16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // FIND YOUR OWN: "M303 E-1 C8 S90" to run autotune on the bed at 90 degreesC for 8 cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents extrusion if the temperature is below EXTRUDE_MINTEMP.
 | 
				
			||||
// It also enables the M302 command to set the minimum extrusion temperature
 | 
				
			||||
// or to allow moving the extruder regardless of the hotend temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// *** IT IS HIGHLY RECOMMENDED TO LEAVE THIS OPTION ENABLED! ***
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_COLD_EXTRUSION
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MINTEMP 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents a single extrusion longer than EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH.
 | 
				
			||||
// Note that for Bowden Extruders a too-small value here may prevent loading.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_LENGTHY_EXTRUDE
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH 200
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//======================== Thermal Runaway Protection =======================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get "Thermal Runaway" or "Heating failed" errors the
 | 
				
			||||
 * details can be tuned in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS // Enable thermal protection for all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED     // Enable thermal protection for the heated bed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Mechanical Settings =========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment one of these options to enable CoreXY, CoreXZ, or CoreYZ kinematics
 | 
				
			||||
// either in the usual order or reversed
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXY
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option for Toshiba steppers
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CONFIG_STEPPERS_TOSHIBA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Endstop Settings ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Specify here all the endstop connectors that are connected to any endstop or probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// Almost all printers will be using one per axis. Probes will use one or more of the
 | 
				
			||||
// extra connectors. Leave undefined any used for non-endstop and non-probe purposes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_XMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_YMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_ZMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_XMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_YMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_ZMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// coarse Endstop Settings
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENDSTOPPULLUPS // Comment this out (using // at the start of the line) to disable the endstop pullup resistors
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(ENDSTOPPULLUPS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // fine endstop settings: Individual pullups. will be ignored if ENDSTOPPULLUPS is defined
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Mechanical endstop with COM to ground and NC to Signal uses "false" here (most common setup).
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING true  // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING true  // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING true  // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP_INVERTING true  // set to true to invert the logic of the probe.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this feature if all enabled endstop pins are interrupt-capable.
 | 
				
			||||
// This will remove the need to poll the interrupt pins, saving many CPU cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOP_INTERRUPTS_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Movement Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section motion
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Settings
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * These settings can be reset by M502
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You can set distinct factors for each E stepper, if needed.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If fewer factors are given, the last will apply to the rest.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note that if EEPROM is enabled, saved values will override these.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Axis Steps Per Unit (steps/mm)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M92
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_AXIS_STEPS_PER_UNIT   { 80, 80, 4000, 52.2 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Feed Rate (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M203
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_FEEDRATE          { 250, 250, 2, 17 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * (Maximum start speed for accelerated moves)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M201
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_ACCELERATION      { 1000, 1000, 4, 750 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M204
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 P    Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 R    Retract Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 T    Travel Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ACCELERATION          500     // X, Y, Z and E acceleration for printing moves
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_RETRACT_ACCELERATION  400     // E acceleration for retracts
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_TRAVEL_ACCELERATION   400     // X, Y, Z acceleration for travel (non printing) moves
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Jerk (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M205 X Y Z E
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Jerk" specifies the minimum speed change that requires acceleration.
 | 
				
			||||
 * When changing speed and direction, if the difference is less than the
 | 
				
			||||
 * value set here, it may happen instantaneously.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_XJERK                 17.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_YJERK                 17.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ZJERK                  0.4
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_EJERK                  4.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Z Probe Options =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section probes
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Probe Type
 | 
				
			||||
// Probes are sensors/switches that are activated / deactivated before/after use.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probes, Servo Probes, Z-Sled Probes, FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
// You must activate one of these to use Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use M851 to set the Z probe vertical offset from the nozzle. Store with M500.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A Fix-Mounted Probe either doesn't deploy or needs manual deployment.
 | 
				
			||||
// For example an inductive probe, or a setup that uses the nozzle to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// An inductive probe must be deactivated to go below
 | 
				
			||||
// its trigger-point if hardware endstops are active.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The BLTouch probe emulates a servo probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// The default connector is SERVO 0. Set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR below to override.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLTOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Servo Probe, such as an endstop switch on a rotating arm.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_SERVO_ANGLES {40,85} // Z Servo Deploy and Stow angles
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if you have a Z probe mounted on a sled like those designed by Charles Bell.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_SLED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SLED_DOCKING_OFFSET 5 // The extra distance the X axis must travel to pickup the sled. 0 should be fine but you can push it further if you'd like.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Probe to nozzle (X,Y) offset, relative to (0, 0).
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y offsets must be integers.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In the following example the X and Y offsets are both positive:
 | 
				
			||||
// #define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
// #define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    +-- BACK ---+
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//  L |    (+) P  | R <-- probe (20,20)
 | 
				
			||||
//  E |           | I
 | 
				
			||||
//  F | (-) N (+) | G <-- nozzle (10,10)
 | 
				
			||||
//  T |           | H
 | 
				
			||||
//    |    (-)    | T
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//    O-- FRONT --+
 | 
				
			||||
//  (0,0)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 38  // X offset: -left  +right  [of the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER -7  // Y offset: -front +behind [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER -9.65   // Z offset: -below +above  [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y axis travel speed (mm/m) between probes
 | 
				
			||||
#define XY_PROBE_SPEED 7500
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the first approach when double-probing (with PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH)
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the "accurate" probe of each point
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_SLOW (Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST / 2)
 | 
				
			||||
// Use double touch for probing
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probe is defined in the Delta example configurations.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// *** PLEASE READ ALL INSTRUCTIONS BELOW FOR SAFETY! ***
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To continue using the Z-min-endstop for homing, be sure to disable Z_SAFE_HOMING.
 | 
				
			||||
// Example: To park the head outside the bed area when homing with G28.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a separate Z probe, your board must define a Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For a servo-based Z probe, just set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR and Z_SERVO_ANGLES above.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - RAMPS 1.3/1.4 boards may be able to use the 5V, GND, and Aux4->D32 pin.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Use 5V for powered (usu. inductive) sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Otherwise connect:
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-closed switches to GND and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-open switches to 5V and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Normally-closed switches are advised and are the default.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN sets the Arduino pin to use. (See your board's pins file.)
 | 
				
			||||
// Since the RAMPS Aux4->D32 pin maps directly to the Arduino D32 pin, D32 is the
 | 
				
			||||
// default pin for all RAMPS-based boards. Most boards use the X_MAX_PIN by default.
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a different pin you can override it here.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING:
 | 
				
			||||
// Setting the wrong pin may have unexpected and potentially disastrous consequences.
 | 
				
			||||
// Use with caution and do your homework.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN X_MAX_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP to use _both_ a Z Probe and a Z-min-endstop on the same machine.
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option the Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN will only be used for probing, never for homing.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN to use the Z_MIN_PIN for your Z_MIN_PROBE.
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PIN will then be used for both Z-homing and probing.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a probe you must enable one of the two options above!
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z Probe Repeatability test to see how accurate your probe is
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_REPEATABILITY_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Z probes require clearance when deploying, stowing, and moving between
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe points to avoid hitting the bed and other hardware.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Servo-mounted probes require extra space for the arm to rotate.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Inductive probes need space to keep from triggering early.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use these settings to specify the distance (mm) to raise the probe (or
 | 
				
			||||
 * lower the bed). The values set here apply over and above any (negative)
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe Z Offset set with Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER, M851, or the LCD.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only integer values >= 1 are valid here.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Example: `M851 Z-5` with a CLEARANCE of 4  =>  9mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     But: `M851 Z+1` with a CLEARANCE of 2  =>  2mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_DEPLOY_PROBE    3 // Z Clearance for Deploy/Stow
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_BETWEEN_PROBES  3 // Z Clearance between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For M851 give a range for adjusting the Z probe offset
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MIN -20
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MAX 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Inverting Stepper Enable Pins (Active Low) use 0, Non Inverting (Active High) use 1
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 0:'Low', 1:'High' }
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define E_ENABLE_ON 0 // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Disables axis stepper immediately when it's not being used.
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING: When motors turn off there is a chance of losing position accuracy!
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_X false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Y false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Z false
 | 
				
			||||
// Warn on display about possibly reduced accuracy
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISABLE_REDUCED_ACCURACY_WARNING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_E false // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_EXTRUDER true //disable only inactive extruders and keep active extruder enabled
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Invert the stepper direction. Change (or reverse the motor connector) if an axis goes the wrong way.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For direct drive extruder v9 set to true, for geared extruder set to false.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E0_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E1_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E2_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E3_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOMING_HEIGHT 2    // (in mm) Minimal z height before homing (G28) for Z clearance above the bed, clamps, ...
 | 
				
			||||
                             // Be sure you have this distance over your Z_MAX_POS in case.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Direction of endstops when homing; 1=MAX, -1=MIN
 | 
				
			||||
// :[-1,1]
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Travel limits after homing (units are in mm)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_POS 203
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_POS 180
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_POS 175
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move below MIN_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MIN_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move above MAX_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Runout Sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * A mechanical or opto endstop is used to check for the presence of filament.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * RAMPS-based boards use SERVO3_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * For other boards you may need to define FIL_RUNOUT_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * By default the firmware assumes HIGH = has filament, LOW = ran out
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FIL_RUNOUT_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the sensor.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENDSTOPPULLUP_FIL_RUNOUT // Uncomment to use internal pullup for filament runout pins if the sensor is defined.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT "M600"
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Bed Leveling ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section bedlevel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select one form of Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  If you're also using the Probe for Z Homing, it's
 | 
				
			||||
 *  highly recommended to enable Z_SAFE_HOMING also!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - 3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe 3 arbitrary points on the bed (that aren't collinear)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the XY coordinates of all 3 points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a mesh, best for large or uneven beds.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - UBL Unified Bed Leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 *   A comprehensive bed leveling system that combines features and benefits from previous
 | 
				
			||||
 *   bed leveling system.  The UBL Bed Leveling System also includes an integrated and easy to use
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Mesh Generation, Mesh Validation and Mesh Editing system.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     - Currently, the UBL Bed Leveling System is only checked out for Cartesian Printers.  But with
 | 
				
			||||
 *       that said, it was primarily designed to handle poor quality Delta Printers.  If you feel
 | 
				
			||||
 *       adventurous and have a Delta, please post an issue if something doesn't work correctly.
 | 
				
			||||
 *       Initially, you will need to reduce your declared bed size so you have a rectangular area to
 | 
				
			||||
 *       test on.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MESH_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable detailed logging of G28, G29, M48, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Turn on with the command 'M111 S32'.
 | 
				
			||||
 * NOTE: Requires a lot of PROGMEM!
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DEBUG_LEVELING_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Gradually reduce leveling correction until a set height is reached,
 | 
				
			||||
  // at which point movement will be level to the machine's XY plane.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The height can be set with M420 Z<height>
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENABLE_LEVELING_FADE_HEIGHT
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the number of grid points per dimension.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X 3
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_Y ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the boundaries for probing (where the probe can reach).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LEFT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RIGHT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FRONT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 10
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BACK_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // The Z probe minimum outer margin (to validate G29 parameters).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_PROBE_EDGE 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Probe along the Y axis, advancing X after each column
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PROBE_Y_FIRST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    // Experimental Subdivision of the grid by Catmull-Rom method.
 | 
				
			||||
    // Synthesizes intermediate points to produce a more detailed mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION
 | 
				
			||||
    #if ENABLED(ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION)
 | 
				
			||||
      // Number of subdivisions between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
      #define BILINEAR_SUBDIVISIONS 3
 | 
				
			||||
    #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // 3 arbitrary points to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
  // A simple cross-product is used to estimate the plane of the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_X 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_X 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 10
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_X 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=================================== Mesh ==================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_PROBE_Z_RANGE 4 // Z after Home, bed somewhere below but above 0.0.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_INSET 10          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 3    // Don't use more than 7 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MESH_G28_REST_ORIGIN // After homing all axes ('G28' or 'G28 XYZ') rest at origin [0,0,0]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MANUAL_BED_LEVELING  // Add display menu option for bed leveling.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(MANUAL_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define MBL_Z_STEP 0.025     // Step size while manually probing Z axis.
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif  // MANUAL_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//========================= Unified Bed Leveling ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_INSET 1          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 10  // Don't use more than 15 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 10
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_X 39       // These set the probe locations for when UBL does a 3-Point leveling
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 180      // of the mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_X 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_X 180
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif  // BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Commands to execute at the end of G29 probing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Useful to retract or move the Z probe out of the way.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_END_SCRIPT "G1 Z10 F12000\nG1 X15 Y330\nG1 Z0.5\nG1 Z10"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The center of the bed is at (X=0, Y=0)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_CENTER_AT_0_0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Manually set the home position. Leave these undefined for automatic settings.
 | 
				
			||||
// For DELTA this is the top-center of the Cartesian print volume.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MANUAL_X_HOME_POS 100
 | 
				
			||||
#define MANUAL_Y_HOME_POS 100
 | 
				
			||||
#define MANUAL_Z_HOME_POS 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use "Z Safe Homing" to avoid homing with a Z probe outside the bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this feature enabled:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - Allow Z homing only after X and Y homing AND stepper drivers still enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// - If stepper drivers time out, it will need X and Y homing again before Z homing.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Move the Z probe (or nozzle) to a defined XY point before Z Homing when homing all axes (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
// - Prevent Z homing when the Z probe is outside bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_SAFE_HOMING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_SAFE_HOMING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_X_POINT ((X_MIN_POS + X_MAX_POS) / 2)    // X point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_Y_POINT ((Y_MIN_POS + Y_MAX_POS) / 2)    // Y point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Homing speeds (mm/m)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_XY (40*60)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z  (55)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Additional Features ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The microcontroller can store settings in the EEPROM, e.g. max velocity...
 | 
				
			||||
// M500 - stores parameters in EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
// M501 - reads parameters from EEPROM (if you need reset them after you changed them temporarily).
 | 
				
			||||
// M502 - reverts to the default "factory settings".  You still need to store them in EEPROM afterwards if you want to.
 | 
				
			||||
//define this to enable EEPROM support
 | 
				
			||||
#define EEPROM_SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EEPROM_SETTINGS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // To disable EEPROM Serial responses and decrease program space by ~1700 byte: comment this out:
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EEPROM_CHITCHAT // Please keep turned on if you can.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Host Keepalive
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will send a busy status message to the host
 | 
				
			||||
// every couple of seconds when it can't accept commands.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOST_KEEPALIVE_FEATURE        // Disable this if your host doesn't like keepalive messages
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_KEEPALIVE_INTERVAL 2  // Number of seconds between "busy" messages. Set with M113.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M100 Free Memory Watcher
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define M100_FREE_MEMORY_WATCHER // uncomment to add the M100 Free Memory Watcher for debug purpose
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// G20/G21 Inch mode support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INCH_MODE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M149 Set temperature units support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMPERATURE_UNITS_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Preheat Constants
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_HOTEND 180
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_BED     70
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_HOTEND 240
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_BED    110
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Nozzle Park -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to define a special XYZ position, inside the
 | 
				
			||||
// machine's topology, to park the nozzle when idle or when receiving the G27
 | 
				
			||||
// command.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The "P" paramenter controls what is the action applied to the Z axis:
 | 
				
			||||
//    P0: (Default) If current Z-pos is lower than Z-park then the nozzle will
 | 
				
			||||
//        be raised to reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P1: No matter the current Z-pos, the nozzle will be raised/lowered to
 | 
				
			||||
//        reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P2: The nozzle height will be raised by Z-park amount but never going over
 | 
				
			||||
//        the machine's limit of Z_MAX_POS.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify a park position as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_PARK_POINT { (X_MIN_POS + 10), (Y_MAX_POS - 10), 20 }
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Clean Nozzle Feature -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to send G12 to start the nozzle cleaning
 | 
				
			||||
// process, the G-Code accepts two parameters:
 | 
				
			||||
//   "P" for pattern selection
 | 
				
			||||
//   "S" for defining the number of strokes/repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Available list of patterns:
 | 
				
			||||
//   P0: This is the default pattern, this process requires a sponge type
 | 
				
			||||
//       material at a fixed bed location. S defines "strokes" i.e.
 | 
				
			||||
//       back-and-forth movements between the starting and end points.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P1: This starts a zig-zag pattern between (X0, Y0) and (X1, Y1), "T"
 | 
				
			||||
//       defines the number of zig-zag triangles to be done. "S" defines the
 | 
				
			||||
//       number of strokes aka one back-and-forth movement. Zig-zags will
 | 
				
			||||
//       be performed in whichever dimension is smallest. As an example,
 | 
				
			||||
//       sending "G12 P1 S1 T3" will execute:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//          --
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y1) |     /\        /\        /\     | (X1, Y1)
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |    /  \      /  \      /  \    |
 | 
				
			||||
//       A |           |   /    \    /    \    /    \   |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |  /      \  /      \  /      \  |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y0) | /        \/        \/        \ | (X1, Y0)
 | 
				
			||||
//          --         +--------------------------------+
 | 
				
			||||
//                       |________|_________|_________|
 | 
				
			||||
//                           T1        T2        T3
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P2: This starts a circular pattern with circle with middle in
 | 
				
			||||
//       NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE radius of R and stroke count of S.
 | 
				
			||||
//       Before starting the circle nozzle goes to NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Caveats: End point Z should use the same value as Start point Z.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Attention: This is an EXPERIMENTAL feature, in the future the G-code arguments
 | 
				
			||||
// may change to add new functionality like different wipe patterns.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of pattern repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_STROKES  12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of triangles
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_TRIANGLES  3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify positions as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT { 30, 30, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_END_POINT   {100, 60, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern radius
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_RADIUS 6.5
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern circle fragments number
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_FN 10
 | 
				
			||||
  // Middle point of circle
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Moves the nozzle to the initial position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_GOBACK
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option to automatically start and stop the
 | 
				
			||||
// print job timer when M104/M109/M190 commands are received.
 | 
				
			||||
// M104 (extruder without wait) - high temp = none, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M109 (extruder with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M190 (bed with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = none
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In all cases the timer can be started and stopped using
 | 
				
			||||
// the following commands:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - M75  - Start the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M76  - Pause the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M77  - Stop the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
#define PRINTJOB_TIMER_AUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print Counter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will keep track of some print statistical data such as:
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total successful print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total failed print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total time printing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This information can be viewed by the M78 command.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PRINTCOUNTER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= LCD and SD support ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD LANGUAGE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Here you may choose the language used by Marlin on the LCD menus, the following
 | 
				
			||||
// list of languages are available:
 | 
				
			||||
//    en, an, bg, ca, cn, cz, de, el, el-gr, es, eu, fi, fr, gl, hr, it,
 | 
				
			||||
//    kana, kana_utf8, nl, pl, pt, pt_utf8, pt-br, pt-br_utf8, ru, tr, uk, test
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 'en':'English', 'an':'Aragonese', 'bg':'Bulgarian', 'ca':'Catalan', 'cn':'Chinese', 'cz':'Czech', 'de':'German', 'el':'Greek', 'el-gr':'Greek (Greece)', 'es':'Spanish', 'eu':'Basque-Euskera', 'fi':'Finnish', 'fr':'French', 'gl':'Galician', 'hr':'Croatian', 'it':'Italian', 'kana':'Japanese', 'kana_utf8':'Japanese (UTF8)', 'nl':'Dutch', 'pl':'Polish', 'pt':'Portuguese', 'pt-br':'Portuguese (Brazilian)', 'pt-br_utf8':'Portuguese (Brazilian UTF8)', 'pt_utf8':'Portuguese (UTF8)', 'ru':'Russian', 'tr':'Turkish', 'uk':'Ukrainian', 'test':'TEST' }
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define LCD_LANGUAGE en
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD Character Set
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This option is NOT applicable to Graphical Displays.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// All character-based LCD's provide ASCII plus one of these
 | 
				
			||||
// language extensions:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - JAPANESE ... the most common
 | 
				
			||||
//  - WESTERN  ... with more accented characters
 | 
				
			||||
//  - CYRILLIC ... for the Russian language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To determine the language extension installed on your controller:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Compile and upload with LCD_LANGUAGE set to 'test'
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Click the controller to view the LCD menu
 | 
				
			||||
//  - The LCD will display Japanese, Western, or Cyrillic text
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// See https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin/wiki/LCD-Language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :['JAPANESE', 'WESTERN', 'CYRILLIC']
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISPLAY_CHARSET_HD44780 JAPANESE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD TYPE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// You may choose ULTRA_LCD if you have character based LCD with 16x2, 16x4, 20x2,
 | 
				
			||||
// 20x4 char/lines or DOGLCD for the full graphics display with 128x64 pixels
 | 
				
			||||
// (ST7565R family). (This option will be set automatically for certain displays.)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// IMPORTANT NOTE: The U8glib library is required for Full Graphic Display!
 | 
				
			||||
//                 https://github.com/olikraus/U8glib_Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTRA_LCD   // Character based
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DOGLCD      // Full graphics display
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD Card support is disabled by default. If your controller has an SD slot,
 | 
				
			||||
// you must uncomment the following option or it won't work.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: SPI SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment ONE of the following items to use a slower SPI transfer
 | 
				
			||||
// speed. This is usually required if you're getting volume init errors.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_HALF_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_QUARTER_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_EIGHTH_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: ENABLE CRC
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use CRC checks and retries on the SD communication.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SD_CHECK_AND_RETRY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ENCODER SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option overrides the default number of encoder pulses needed to
 | 
				
			||||
// produce one step. Should be increased for high-resolution encoders.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_PULSES_PER_STEP 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use this option to override the number of step signals required to
 | 
				
			||||
// move between next/prev menu items.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_STEPS_PER_MENU_ITEM 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Encoder Direction Options
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Test your encoder's behavior first with both options disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Edit and Menu Nav? Enable REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Menu Navigation only?    Enable REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Editing only?      Enable BOTH options.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction everywhere
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  Set this option if CLOCKWISE causes values to DECREASE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction for navigating LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves DOWN this makes it go UP.
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves UP this makes it go DOWN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Individual Axis Homing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Add individual axis homing items (Home X, Home Y, and Home Z) to the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INDIVIDUAL_AXIS_HOMING_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SPEAKER/BUZZER
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you have a speaker that can produce tones, enable it here.
 | 
				
			||||
// By default Marlin assumes you have a buzzer with a fixed frequency.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPEAKER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The duration and frequency for the UI feedback sound.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set these to 0 to disable audio feedback in the LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Test audio output with the G-Code:
 | 
				
			||||
//  M300 S<frequency Hz> P<duration ms>
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_DURATION_MS 100
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_HZ 1000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Standard
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin supports a wide variety of controllers.
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable one of the following options to specify your controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIMAKER Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIMAKERCONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIPANEL as seen on Thingiverse.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Cartesio UI
 | 
				
			||||
// http://mauk.cc/webshop/cartesio-shop/electronics/user-interface
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CARTESIO_UI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PanelOne from T3P3 (via RAMPS 1.4 AUX2/AUX3)
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/PanelOne
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PANEL_ONE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MaKr3d Makr-Panel with graphic controller and SD support.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/MaKr3d_MaKrPanel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAKRPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ReprapWorld Graphical LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// https://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id/1218
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_GRAPHICAL_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Activate one of these if you have a Panucatt Devices
 | 
				
			||||
// Viki 2.0 or mini Viki with Graphic LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// http://panucatt.com
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VIKI2
 | 
				
			||||
//#define miniVIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Adafruit ST7565 Full Graphic Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// https://github.com/eboston/Adafruit-ST7565-Full-Graphic-Controller/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount Smart Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a white PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// GADGETS3D G3D LCD/SD Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RAMPS_1.3/1.4_GADGETS3D_Shield_with_Panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a blue PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G3D_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount FULL GRAPHIC Smart Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Full_Graphic_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_FULL_GRAPHIC_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MakerLab Mini Panel with graphic
 | 
				
			||||
// controller and SD support - http://reprap.org/wiki/Mini_panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MINIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapWorld REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD v1.1
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id=202&cPath=1591_1626
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP sets how much should the robot move when a key
 | 
				
			||||
// is pressed, a value of 10.0 means 10mm per click.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP 1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RigidBot Panel V1.0
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.inventapart.com/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RIGIDBOT_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// BQ LCD Smart Controller shipped by
 | 
				
			||||
// default with the BQ Hephestos 2 and Witbox 2.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BQ_LCD_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: These controllers require the installation of Arduino's LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// library. For more info: https://github.com/kiyoshigawa/LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Elefu RA Board Control Panel
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.elefu.com/index.php?route=product/product&product_id=53
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RA_CONTROL_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Sainsmart YW Robot (LCM1602) LCD Display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_SAINSMART_YWROBOT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Generic LCM1602 LCD adapter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCM1602
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PANELOLU2 LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// separate encoder and click inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This controller requires Arduino's LiquidTWI2 library v1.2.3 or later.
 | 
				
			||||
// For more info: https://github.com/lincomatic/LiquidTWI2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: The PANELOLU2 encoder click input can either be directly connected to
 | 
				
			||||
// a pin (if BTN_ENC defined to != -1) or read through I2C (when BTN_ENC == -1).
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_PANELOLU2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Panucatt VIKI LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// integrated click & L/R/U/D buttons, separate encoder inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_VIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SSD1306 OLED full graphics generic display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SAV OLEd LCD module support using either SSD1306 or SH1106 based LCD modules
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SAV_3DGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
  #define U8GLIB_SH1106
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Shift register panels
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// 2 wire Non-latching LCD SR from https://goo.gl/aJJ4sH
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD configuration: http://reprap.org/wiki/SAV_3D_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Extra Features ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Increase the FAN PWM frequency. Removes the PWM noise but increases heating in the FET/Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAST_PWM_FAN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use software PWM to drive the fan, as for the heaters. This uses a very low frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// which is not as annoying as with the hardware PWM. On the other hand, if this frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// is too low, you should also increment SOFT_PWM_SCALE.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_SOFT_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Incrementing this by 1 will double the software PWM frequency,
 | 
				
			||||
// affecting heaters, and the fan if FAN_SOFT_PWM is enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// However, control resolution will be halved for each increment;
 | 
				
			||||
// at zero value, there are 128 effective control positions.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SOFT_PWM_SCALE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Temperature status LEDs that display the hotend and bed temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// If all hotends and bed temperature and temperature setpoint are < 54C then the BLUE led is on.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise the RED led is on. There is 1C hysteresis.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_STAT_LEDS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// M240  Triggers a camera by emulating a Canon RC-1 Remote
 | 
				
			||||
// Data from: http://www.doc-diy.net/photo/rc-1_hacked/
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PHOTOGRAPH_PIN     23
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// SkeinForge sends the wrong arc g-codes when using Arc Point as fillet procedure
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SF_ARC_FIX
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for the BariCUDA Paste Extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BARICUDA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//define BlinkM/CyzRgb Support
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLINKM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for an RGB LED using 3 separate pins with optional PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RGB_LED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(RGB_LED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_R_PIN 34
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_G_PIN 43
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_B_PIN 35
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/*********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
* R/C SERVO support
 | 
				
			||||
* Sponsored by TrinityLabs, Reworked by codexmas
 | 
				
			||||
**********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of servos
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you select a configuration below, this will receive a default value and does not need to be set manually
 | 
				
			||||
// set it manually if you have more servos than extruders and wish to manually control some
 | 
				
			||||
// leaving it undefined or defining as 0 will disable the servo subsystem
 | 
				
			||||
// If unsure, leave commented / disabled
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define NUM_SERVOS 2 // Servo index starts with 0 for M280 command
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Delay (in milliseconds) before the next move will start, to give the servo time to reach its target angle.
 | 
				
			||||
// 300ms is a good value but you can try less delay.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the servo can't reach the requested position, increase it.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERVO_DELAY 500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Servo deactivation
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option servos are powered only during movement, then turned off to prevent jitter.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEACTIVATE_SERVOS_AFTER_MOVE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
 * Support for a filament diameter sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also allows adjustment of diameter at print time (vs  at slicing)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Single extruder only at this point (extruder 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 * 34 - RAMPS1.4 - uses Analog input 5 on the AUX2 connector
 | 
				
			||||
 * 81 - Printrboard - Uses Analog input 2 on the Exp1 connector (version B,C,D,E)
 | 
				
			||||
 * 301 - Rambo  - uses Analog input 3
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note may require analog pins to be defined for different motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 **********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment below to enable
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA 1.75  //Enter the diameter (in mm) of the filament generally used (3.0 mm or 1.75 mm) - this is then used in the slicer software.  Used for sensor reading validation
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_SENSOR_EXTRUDER_NUM 0   //The number of the extruder that has the filament sensor (0,1,2)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM        14   //measurement delay in cm.  This is the distance from filament sensor to middle of barrel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_UPPER_LIMIT         3.30  //upper limit factor used for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_LOWER_LIMIT         1.90  //lower limit factor for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MAX_MEASUREMENT_DELAY       20     //delay buffer size in bytes (1 byte = 1cm)- limits maximum measurement delay allowable (must be larger than MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM  and lower number saves RAM)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_MEASURED_FILAMENT_DIA  DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA  //set measured to nominal initially
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //When using an LCD, uncomment the line below to display the Filament sensor data on the last line instead of status.  Status will appear for 5 sec.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define FILAMENT_LCD_DISPLAY
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
@ -1,1091 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only change these if you know exactly what you're doing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these settings can damage your printer if improperly set!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings can be found in Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Thermal Settings  ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BED_CHECK_INTERVAL 5000 // ms between checks in bang-bang control
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Only disable heating if T>target+BED_HYSTERESIS and enable heating if T>target-BED_HYSTERESIS
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The solution: Once the temperature reaches the target, start observing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If the temperature stays too far below the target (hysteresis) for too long (period),
 | 
				
			||||
 * the firmware will halt the machine as a safety precaution.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get false positives for "Thermal Runaway" increase THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS and/or THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD 40        // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS 2     // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M104 or M109 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M104/M109,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get false positives for "Heating failed" increase WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD 40                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection parameters for the bed are just as above for hotends.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_PERIOD 40    // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M140 or M190 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M140/M190,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get too many "Heating failed" errors, increase WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE. (WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD 60                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  // this adds an experimental additional term to the heating power, proportional to the extrusion speed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if Kc is chosen well, the additional required power due to increased melting should be compensated.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define DEFAULT_Kc (100) //heating power=Kc*(e_speed)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define LPQ_MAX_LEN 50
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Automatic Temperature:
 | 
				
			||||
 * The hotend target temperature is calculated by all the buffered lines of gcode.
 | 
				
			||||
 * The maximum buffered steps/sec of the extruder motor is called "se".
 | 
				
			||||
 * Start autotemp mode with M109 S<mintemp> B<maxtemp> F<factor>
 | 
				
			||||
 * The target temperature is set to mintemp+factor*se[steps/sec] and is limited by
 | 
				
			||||
 * mintemp and maxtemp. Turn this off by executing M109 without F*
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also, if the temperature is set to a value below mintemp, it will not be changed by autotemp.
 | 
				
			||||
 * On an Ultimaker, some initial testing worked with M109 S215 B260 F1 in the start.gcode
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define AUTOTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTOTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTOTEMP_OLDWEIGHT 0.98
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//Show Temperature ADC value
 | 
				
			||||
//The M105 command return, besides traditional information, the ADC value read from temperature sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_TEMP_ADC_VALUES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * High Temperature Thermistor Support
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermistors able to support high temperature tend to have a hard time getting
 | 
				
			||||
 * good readings at room and lower temperatures. This means HEATER_X_RAW_LO_TEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 * will probably be caught when the heating element first turns on during the
 | 
				
			||||
 * preheating process, which will trigger a min_temp_error as a safety measure
 | 
				
			||||
 * and force stop everything.
 | 
				
			||||
 * To circumvent this limitation, we allow for a preheat time (during which,
 | 
				
			||||
 * min_temp_error won't be triggered) and add a min_temp buffer to handle
 | 
				
			||||
 * aberrant readings.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you want to enable this feature for your hotend thermistor(s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * uncomment and set values > 0 in the constants below
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of consecutive low temperature errors that can occur
 | 
				
			||||
// before a min_temp_error is triggered. (Shouldn't be more than 10.)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAX_CONSECUTIVE_LOW_TEMPERATURE_ERROR_ALLOWED 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of milliseconds a hotend will preheat before starting to check
 | 
				
			||||
// the temperature. This value should NOT be set to the time it takes the
 | 
				
			||||
// hot end to reach the target temperature, but the time it takes to reach
 | 
				
			||||
// the minimum temperature your thermistor can read. The lower the better/safer.
 | 
				
			||||
// This shouldn't need to be more than 30 seconds (30000)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MILLISECONDS_PREHEAT_TIME 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder runout prevention.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the machine is idle and the temperature over MINTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
// then extrude some filament every couple of SECONDS.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_MINTEMP 190
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SECONDS 30
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SPEED 1500  // mm/m
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_EXTRUDE 5   // mm
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//These defines help to calibrate the AD595 sensor in case you get wrong temperature measurements.
 | 
				
			||||
//The measured temperature is defined as "actualTemp = (measuredTemp * TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN) + TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET"
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET 0.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN   1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//This is for controlling a fan to cool down the stepper drivers
 | 
				
			||||
//it will turn on when any driver is enabled
 | 
				
			||||
//and turn off after the set amount of seconds from last driver being disabled again
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_PIN -1 //Pin used for the fan to cool controller (-1 to disable)
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SECS 60 //How many seconds, after all motors were disabled, the fan should run
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SPEED 255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When first starting the main fan, run it at full speed for the
 | 
				
			||||
// given number of milliseconds.  This gets the fan spinning reliably
 | 
				
			||||
// before setting a PWM value. (Does not work with software PWM for fan on Sanguinololu)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_KICKSTART_TIME 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the minimal speed for the main fan, run in PWM mode
 | 
				
			||||
// to enable uncomment and set minimal PWM speed for reliable running (1-255)
 | 
				
			||||
// if fan speed is [1 - (FAN_MIN_PWM-1)] it is set to FAN_MIN_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_MIN_PWM 50
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder cooling fans
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder auto fans automatically turn on when their extruders'
 | 
				
			||||
 * temperatures go above EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Your board's pins file specifies the recommended pins. Override those here
 | 
				
			||||
 * or set to -1 to disable completely.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Multiple extruders can be assigned to the same pin in which case
 | 
				
			||||
 * the fan will turn on when any selected extruder is above the threshold.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define E0_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E1_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E2_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E3_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE 50
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_SPEED   255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define a pin to turn case light on/off
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CASE_LIGHT_PIN 4
 | 
				
			||||
#if PIN_EXISTS(CASE_LIGHT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_CASE_LIGHT false   // Set to true if HIGH is the OFF state (active low)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define CASE_LIGHT_DEFAULT_ON   // Uncomment to set default state to on
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ITEM_CASE_LIGHT    // Uncomment to have a Case Light On / Off entry in main menu
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================ Mechanical Settings ==========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If you want endstops to stay on (by default) even when not homing
 | 
				
			||||
// enable this option. Override at any time with M120, M121.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOPS_ALWAYS_ON_DEFAULT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_LATE_ENABLE // Enable Z the last moment. Needed if your Z driver overheats.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual X Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two X axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second X stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two X motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_X2_VS_X_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual Y Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two Y axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Y stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two Y motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_Y2_VS_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A single Z stepper driver is usually used to drive 2 stepper motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to use a separate stepper driver for each Z axis motor.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Z stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS is a feature to enable the use of 2 endstops for both Z steppers - Let's call them Z stepper and Z2 stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
  // That way the machine is capable to align the bed during home, since both Z steppers are homed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // There is also an implementation of M666 (software endstops adjustment) to this feature.
 | 
				
			||||
  // After Z homing, this adjustment is applied to just one of the steppers in order to align the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // One just need to home the Z axis and measure the distance difference between both Z axis and apply the math: Z adjust = Z - Z2.
 | 
				
			||||
  // If the Z stepper axis is closer to the bed, the measure Z > Z2 (yes, it is.. think about it) and the Z adjust would be positive.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Play a little bit with small adjustments (0.5mm) and check the behaviour.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The M119 (endstops report) will start reporting the Z2 Endstop as well.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define Z2_USE_ENDSTOP _XMAX_
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this for dual x-carriage printers.
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual x-carriage design has the advantage that the inactive extruder can be parked which
 | 
				
			||||
// prevents hot-end ooze contaminating the print. It also reduces the weight of each x-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
// allowing faster printing speeds. Connect your X2 stepper to the first unused E plug.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DUAL_X_CARRIAGE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Configuration for second X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: the first x-carriage is defined as the x-carriage which homes to the minimum endstop;
 | 
				
			||||
  // the second x-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MIN_POS 80     // set minimum to ensure second x-carriage doesn't hit the parked first X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_POS 353    // set maximum to the distance between toolheads when both heads are homed
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_DIR 1     // the second X-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_POS X2_MAX_POS // default home position is the maximum carriage position
 | 
				
			||||
      // However: In this mode the HOTEND_OFFSET_X value for the second extruder provides a software
 | 
				
			||||
      // override for X2_HOME_POS. This also allow recalibration of the distance between the two endstops
 | 
				
			||||
      // without modifying the firmware (through the "M218 T1 X???" command).
 | 
				
			||||
      // Remember: you should set the second extruder x-offset to 0 in your slicer.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // There are a few selectable movement modes for dual x-carriages using M605 S<mode>
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 0 (DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE): Full control. The slicer has full control over both x-carriages and can achieve optimal travel results
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    as long as it supports dual x-carriages. (M605 S0)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 1 (DXC_AUTO_PARK_MODE)   : Auto-park mode. The firmware will automatically park and unpark the x-carriages on tool changes so
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    that additional slicer support is not required. (M605 S1)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 2 (DXC_DUPLICATION_MODE) : Duplication mode. The firmware will transparently make the second x-carriage and extruder copy all
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    actions of the first x-carriage. This allows the printer to print 2 arbitrary items at
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    once. (2nd extruder x offset and temp offset are set using: M605 S2 [Xnnn] [Rmmm])
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This is the default power-up mode which can be later using M605.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUAL_X_CARRIAGE_MODE DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default settings in "Auto-park Mode"
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_PARK_ZLIFT   0.2      // the distance to raise Z axis when parking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_UNPARK_ZLIFT 1        // the distance to raise Z axis when unparking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default x offset in duplication mode (typically set to half print bed width)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUPLICATION_X_OFFSET 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif //DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//homing hits the endstop, then retracts by this distance, before it tries to slowly bump again:
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_BUMP_MM 2
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_BUMP_DIVISOR {2, 2, 4}  // Re-Bump Speed Divisor (Divides the Homing Feedrate)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define QUICK_HOME  //if this is defined, if both x and y are to be homed, a diagonal move will be performed initially.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When G28 is called, this option will make Y home before X
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOME_Y_BEFORE_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define AXIS_RELATIVE_MODES {false, false, false, false}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Allow duplication mode with a basic dual-nozzle extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_NOZZLE_DUPLICATION_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// By default pololu step drivers require an active high signal. However, some high power drivers require an active low signal as step.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default stepper release if idle. Set to 0 to deactivate.
 | 
				
			||||
// Steppers will shut down DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME seconds after the last move when DISABLE_INACTIVE_? is true.
 | 
				
			||||
// Time can be set by M18 and M84.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME 120
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_X true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Y true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Z true  // set to false if the nozzle will fall down on your printed part when print has finished.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_E true
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINIMUMFEEDRATE       0.0     // minimum feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINTRAVELFEEDRATE     0.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ULTIPANEL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_FEEDRATE {50*60, 50*60, 4*60, 60} // Feedrates for manual moves along X, Y, Z, E from panel
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ULTIPANEL_FEEDMULTIPLY  // Comment to disable setting feedrate multiplier via encoder
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// minimum time in microseconds that a movement needs to take if the buffer is emptied.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINSEGMENTTIME        20000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If defined the movements slow down when the look ahead buffer is only half full
 | 
				
			||||
#define SLOWDOWN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Frequency limit
 | 
				
			||||
// See nophead's blog for more info
 | 
				
			||||
// Not working O
 | 
				
			||||
//#define XY_FREQUENCY_LIMIT  15
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Minimum planner junction speed. Sets the default minimum speed the planner plans for at the end
 | 
				
			||||
// of the buffer and all stops. This should not be much greater than zero and should only be changed
 | 
				
			||||
// if unwanted behavior is observed on a user's machine when running at very slow speeds.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_PLANNER_SPEED 0.05// (mm/sec)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Microstep setting (Only functional when stepper driver microstep pins are connected to MCU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MICROSTEP_MODES {16,16,16,16,16} // [1,2,4,8,16]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current setting (Only functional when motor driver current ref pins are connected to a digital trimpot on supported boards)
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_MOTOR_CURRENT {135,135,135,135,135} // Values 0-255 (RAMBO 135 = ~0.75A, 185 = ~1A)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current controlled via PWM (Overridable on supported boards with PWM-driven motor driver current)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PWM_MOTOR_CURRENT {1300, 1300, 1250} // Values in milliamps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// uncomment to enable an I2C based DIGIPOT like on the Azteeg X3 Pro
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DIGIPOT_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of channels available for I2C digipot, For Azteeg X3 Pro we have 8
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS 8
 | 
				
			||||
// actual motor currents in Amps, need as many here as DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_MOTOR_CURRENTS {1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Additional Features===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_RATE_MULTIPLIER         // If defined, certain menu edit operations automatically multiply the steps when the encoder is moved quickly
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_10X_STEPS_PER_SEC 75    // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x10 to quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_100X_STEPS_PER_SEC 160  // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x100 to really quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CHDK 4        //Pin for triggering CHDK to take a picture see how to use it here http://captain-slow.dk/2014/03/09/3d-printing-timelapses/
 | 
				
			||||
#define CHDK_DELAY 50 //How long in ms the pin should stay HIGH before going LOW again
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Include a page of printer information in the LCD Main Menu
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_INFO_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// On the Info Screen, display XY with one decimal place when possible
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_DECIMAL_SMALL_XY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The timeout (in ms) to return to the status screen from sub-menus
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_TIMEOUT_TO_STATUS 15000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Some RAMPS and other boards don't detect when an SD card is inserted. You can work
 | 
				
			||||
  // around this by connecting a push button or single throw switch to the pin defined
 | 
				
			||||
  // as SD_DETECT_PIN in your board's pins definitions.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This setting should be disabled unless you are using a push button, pulling the pin to ground.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: This is always disabled for ULTIPANEL (except ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_DETECT_INVERTED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_STEPPERRELEASE true  //if sd support and the file is finished: disable steppers?
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_RELEASECOMMAND "M84 X Y Z E" // You might want to keep the z enabled so your bed stays in place.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SDCARD_RATHERRECENTFIRST  //reverse file order of sd card menu display. Its sorted practically after the file system block order.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if a file is deleted, it frees a block. hence, the order is not purely chronological. To still have auto0.g accessible, there is again the option to do that.
 | 
				
			||||
  // using:
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ADDAUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Sort SD file listings in alphabetical order.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * With this option enabled, items on SD cards will be sorted
 | 
				
			||||
   * by name for easier navigation.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * By default...
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Use the slowest -but safest- method for sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Folders are sorted to the top.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - The sort key is statically allocated.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - No added G-code (M34) support.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - 40 item sorting limit. (Items after the first 40 are unsorted.)
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * SD sorting uses static allocation (as set by SDSORT_LIMIT), allowing the
 | 
				
			||||
   * compiler to calculate the worst-case usage and throw an error if the SRAM
 | 
				
			||||
   * limit is exceeded.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_RAM provides faster sorting via a static directory buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_STACK does the same, but uses a local stack-based buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES will retain the sorted file listing in RAM. (Expensive!)
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM only uses RAM when the SD menu is visible. (Use with caution!)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // SD Card Sorting options
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_LIMIT       40     // Maximum number of sorted items (10-256).
 | 
				
			||||
    #define FOLDER_SORTING     -1     // -1=above  0=none  1=below
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_GCODE       false  // Allow turning sorting on/off with LCD and M34 g-code.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_RAM    false  // Pre-allocate a static array for faster pre-sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_STACK  false  // Prefer the stack for pre-sorting to give back some SRAM. (Negated by next 2 options.)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES false  // Keep sorted items in RAM longer for speedy performance. Most expensive option.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM false  // Use dynamic allocation (within SD menus). Least expensive option. Set SDSORT_LIMIT before use!
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Show a progress bar on HD44780 LCDs for SD printing
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(LCD_PROGRESS_BAR)
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the bar
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_BAR_TIME 2000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the status message
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_MSG_TIME 3000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to retain the status message (0=forever)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_MSG_EXPIRE   0
 | 
				
			||||
    // Enable this to show messages for MSG_TIME then hide them
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define PROGRESS_MSG_ONCE
 | 
				
			||||
    // Add a menu item to test the progress bar:
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This allows hosts to request long names for files and folders with M33
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LONG_FILENAME_HOST_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This option allows you to abort SD printing when any endstop is triggered.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This feature must be enabled with "M540 S1" or from the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
  // To have any effect, endstops must be enabled during SD printing.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ABORT_ON_ENDSTOP_HIT_FEATURE_ENABLED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Additional options for Graphical Displays
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use the optimizations here to improve printing performance,
 | 
				
			||||
 * which can be adversely affected by graphical display drawing,
 | 
				
			||||
 * especially when doing several short moves, and when printing
 | 
				
			||||
 * on DELTA and SCARA machines.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these options may result in the display lagging behind
 | 
				
			||||
 * controller events, as there is a trade-off between reliable
 | 
				
			||||
 * printing performance versus fast display updates.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DOGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on the Info Screen
 | 
				
			||||
  #define XYZ_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on Menu Screens
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MENU_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A bigger font is available for edit items. Costs 3120 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_BIG_EDIT_FONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A smaller font may be used on the Info Screen. Costs 2300 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_SMALL_INFOFONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option and reduce the value to optimize screen updates.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The normal delay is 10µs. Use the lowest value that still gives a reliable display.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DOGM_SPI_DELAY_US 5
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // DOGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section safety
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The hardware watchdog should reset the microcontroller disabling all outputs,
 | 
				
			||||
// in case the firmware gets stuck and doesn't do temperature regulation.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_WATCHDOG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(USE_WATCHDOG)
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you have a watchdog reboot in an ArduinoMega2560 then the device will hang forever, as a watchdog reset will leave the watchdog on.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The "WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL" goes around this by not using the hardware reset.
 | 
				
			||||
  //  However, THIS FEATURE IS UNSAFE!, as it will only work if interrupts are disabled. And the code could hang in an interrupt routine with interrupts disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Babystepping enables the user to control the axis in tiny amounts, independently from the normal printing process
 | 
				
			||||
// it can e.g. be used to change z-positions in the print startup phase in real-time
 | 
				
			||||
// does not respect endstops!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Roxy_work)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(BABYSTEPPING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_XY  //not only z, but also XY in the menu. more clutter, more functions
 | 
				
			||||
                       //not implemented for deltabots!
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_INVERT_Z false  //true for inverse movements in Z
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_MULTIPLICATOR 2 //faster movements
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// extruder advance constant (s2/mm3)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// advance (steps) = STEPS_PER_CUBIC_MM_E * EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K * cubic mm per second ^ 2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Hooke's law says:    force = k * distance
 | 
				
			||||
// Bernoulli's principle says:  v ^ 2 / 2 + g . h + pressure / density = constant
 | 
				
			||||
// so: v ^ 2 is proportional to number of steps we advance the extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K .0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define D_FILAMENT 2.85
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Implementation of linear pressure control
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Assumption: advance = k * (delta velocity)
 | 
				
			||||
 * K=0 means advance disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 * See Marlin documentation for calibration instructions.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LIN_ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(LIN_ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_K 75
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Some Slicers produce Gcode with randomly jumping extrusion widths occasionally.
 | 
				
			||||
   * For example within a 0.4mm perimeter it may produce a single segment of 0.05mm width.
 | 
				
			||||
   * While this is harmless for normal printing (the fluid nature of the filament will
 | 
				
			||||
   * close this very, very tiny gap), it throws off the LIN_ADVANCE pressure adaption.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * For this case LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO can be used to set the extrusion:distance ratio
 | 
				
			||||
   * to a fixed value. Note that using a fixed ratio will lead to wrong nozzle pressures
 | 
				
			||||
   * if the slicer is using variable widths or layer heights within one print!
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * This option sets the default E:D ratio at startup. Use `M905` to override this value.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example: `M905 W0.4 H0.2 D1.75`, where:
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - W is the extrusion width in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - H is the layer height in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - D is the filament diameter in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Set to 0 to auto-detect the ratio based on given Gcode G1 print moves.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Slic3r (including Prusa Slic3r) produces Gcode compatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Cura (as of this writing) may produce Gcode incompatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO 0 // The calculated ratio (or 0) according to the formula W * H / ((D / 2) ^ 2 * PI)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Example: 0.4 * 0.2 / ((1.75 / 2) ^ 2 * PI) = 0.033260135
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default mesh area is an area with an inset margin on the print area.
 | 
				
			||||
// Below are the macros that are used to define the borders for the mesh area,
 | 
				
			||||
// made available here for specialized needs, ie dual extruder setup.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Arc interpretation settings:
 | 
				
			||||
#define ARC_SUPPORT  // Disabling this saves ~2738 bytes
 | 
				
			||||
#define MM_PER_ARC_SEGMENT 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define N_ARC_CORRECTION 25
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for G5 with XYZE destination and IJPQ offsets. Requires ~2666 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BEZIER_CURVE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// G38.2 and G38.3 Probe Target
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G38_PROBE_TARGET
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(G38_PROBE_TARGET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define G38_MINIMUM_MOVE 0.0275 // minimum distance in mm that will produce a move (determined using the print statement in check_move)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Moves (or segments) with fewer steps than this will be joined with the next move
 | 
				
			||||
#define MIN_STEPS_PER_SEGMENT 6
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimum pulse width (in µs) for stepping a stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set this if you find stepping unreliable, or if using a very fast CPU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_STEPPER_PULSE 0 // (µs) The smallest stepper pulse allowed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Control heater 0 and heater 1 in parallel.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HEATERS_PARALLEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//================================= Buffers =================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section hidden
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of linear motions that can be in the plan at any give time.
 | 
				
			||||
// THE BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE NEEDS TO BE A POWER OF 2, i.g. 8,16,32 because shifts and ors are used to do the ring-buffering.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // SD,LCD,Buttons take more memory, block buffer needs to be smaller
 | 
				
			||||
#else
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // maximize block buffer
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section serial
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The ASCII buffer for serial input
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_CMD_SIZE 96
 | 
				
			||||
#define BUFSIZE 4
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Transfer Buffer Size
 | 
				
			||||
// To save 386 bytes of PROGMEM (and TX_BUFFER_SIZE+3 bytes of RAM) set to 0.
 | 
				
			||||
// To buffer a simple "ok" you need 4 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For ADVANCED_OK (M105) you need 32 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For debug-echo: 128 bytes for the optimal speed.
 | 
				
			||||
// Other output doesn't need to be that speedy.
 | 
				
			||||
// :[0, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256]
 | 
				
			||||
#define TX_BUFFER_SIZE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable an emergency-command parser to intercept certain commands as they
 | 
				
			||||
// enter the serial receive buffer, so they cannot be blocked.
 | 
				
			||||
// Currently handles M108, M112, M410
 | 
				
			||||
// Does not work on boards using AT90USB (USBCON) processors!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EMERGENCY_PARSER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bad Serial-connections can miss a received command by sending an 'ok'
 | 
				
			||||
// Therefore some clients abort after 30 seconds in a timeout.
 | 
				
			||||
// Some other clients start sending commands while receiving a 'wait'.
 | 
				
			||||
// This "wait" is only sent when the buffer is empty. 1 second is a good value here.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_TIMEOUTS 1000 // Milliseconds
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Some clients will have this feature soon. This could make the NO_TIMEOUTS unnecessary.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCED_OK
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section fwretract
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Firmware based and LCD controlled retract
 | 
				
			||||
// M207 and M208 can be used to define parameters for the retraction.
 | 
				
			||||
// The retraction can be called by the slicer using G10 and G11
 | 
				
			||||
// until then, intended retractions can be detected by moves that only extrude and the direction.
 | 
				
			||||
// the moves are than replaced by the firmware controlled ones.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FWRETRACT  //ONLY PARTIALLY TESTED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FWRETRACT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_RETRACT 0.1                //minimum extruded mm to accept a automatic gcode retraction attempt
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH 3               //default retract length (positive mm)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH_SWAP 13         //default swap retract length (positive mm), for extruder change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_FEEDRATE 45            //default feedrate for retracting (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_ZLIFT 0                //default retract Z-lift
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH 0       //default additional recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH_SWAP 0  //default additional swap recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering from extruder change)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_FEEDRATE 8     //default feedrate for recovering from retraction (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Change
 | 
				
			||||
 * Experimental filament change support.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Adds the GCode M600 for initiating filament change.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Requires an LCD display.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is required for the default FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Roxy_work)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_X_POS 3             // X position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Y_POS 3             // Y position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_ADD 10            // Z addition of hotend (lift)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_XY_FEEDRATE 100     // X and Y axes feedrate in mm/s (also used for delta printers Z axis)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_FEEDRATE 5        // Z axis feedrate in mm/s (not used for delta printers)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_FEEDRATE 60 // Initial retract feedrate in mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_LENGTH 2    // Initial retract in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // It is a short retract used immediately after print interrupt before move to filament exchange position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_FEEDRATE 10  // Unload filament feedrate in mm/s - filament unloading can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_LENGTH 100   // Unload filament length from hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to unload filament from whole bowden tube,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // shorter length for printers without bowden to unload filament from extruder only,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable unloading for manual unloading
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_FEEDRATE 6     // Load filament feedrate in mm/s - filament loading into the bowden tube can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_LENGTH 0       // Load filament length over hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to fast load filament into whole bowden tube over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Short or zero length for printers without bowden where loading is not used
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_FEEDRATE 3  // Extrude filament feedrate in mm/s - must be slower than load feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_LENGTH 50   // Extrude filament length in mm after filament is loaded over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable for manual extrusion
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Filament can be extruded repeatedly from the filament exchange menu to fill the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // or until outcoming filament color is not clear for filament color change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NOZZLE_TIMEOUT 45L  // Turn off nozzle if user doesn't change filament within this time limit in seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NUMBER_OF_ALERT_BEEPS  5L  // Number of alert beeps before printer goes quiet
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NO_STEPPER_TIMEOUT         // Enable to have stepper motors hold position during filament change
 | 
				
			||||
                                                     // even if it takes longer than DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section tmc
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have TMC26X motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You will need to import the TMC26XStepper library into the Arduino IDE for this
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/trinamic/TMC26XStepper.git)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMCDRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMCDRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000 // in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_SENSE_RESISTOR    91 // in mOhms
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this for SilentStepStick Trinamic TMC2130 SPI-configurable stepper drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You'll also need the TMC2130Stepper Arduino library
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper).
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * To use TMC2130 stepper drivers in SPI mode connect your SPI2130 pins to
 | 
				
			||||
 * the hardware SPI interface on your board and define the required CS pins
 | 
				
			||||
 * in your `pins_MYBOARD.h` file. (e.g., RAMPS 1.4 uses AUX3 pins `X_CS_PIN 53`, `Y_CS_PIN 49`, etc.).
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define STEALTHCHOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Let Marlin automatically control stepper current.
 | 
				
			||||
   * This is still an experimental feature.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Increase current every 5s by CURRENT_STEP until stepper temperature prewarn gets triggered,
 | 
				
			||||
   * then decrease current by CURRENT_STEP until temperature prewarn is cleared.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Adjusting starts from X/Y/Z/E_MAX_CURRENT but will not increase over AUTO_ADJUST_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define AUTOMATIC_CURRENT_CONTROL
 | 
				
			||||
  #define CURRENT_STEP          50  // [mA]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTO_ADJUST_MAX     1300  // [mA], 1300mA_rms = 1840mA_peak
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // CHOOSE YOUR MOTORS HERE, THIS IS MANDATORY
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Stepper driver settings
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define R_SENSE           0.11  // R_sense resistor for SilentStepStick2130
 | 
				
			||||
  #define HOLD_MULTIPLIER    0.5  // Scales down the holding current from run current
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INTERPOLATE          1  // Interpolate X/Y/Z_MICROSTEPS to 256
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000  // rms current in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16  // FULLSTEP..256
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_CHIP_SELECT       40  // Pin
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_CHIP_SELECT       42
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_CHIP_SELECT       65
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * You can set your own advanced settings by filling in predefined functions.
 | 
				
			||||
   * A list of available functions can be found on the library github page
 | 
				
			||||
   * https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example:
 | 
				
			||||
   * #define TMC2130_ADV() { \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.diag0_temp_prewarn(1); \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.interpolate(0); \
 | 
				
			||||
   * }
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  TMC2130_ADV() {  }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have L6470 motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You need to import the L6470 library into the Arduino IDE for this.
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/ameyer/Arduino-L6470)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section l6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_L6470DRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_L6470DRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS      16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_K_VAL           50 // 0 - 255, Higher values, are higher power. Be careful not to go too high
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_OVERCURRENT   2000 // maxc current in mA. If the current goes over this value, the driver will switch off
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_STALLCURRENT  1500 // current in mA where the driver will detect a stall
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * TWI/I2C BUS
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is an EXPERIMENTAL feature so it shall not be used on production
 | 
				
			||||
 * machines. Enabling this will allow you to send and receive I2C data from slave
 | 
				
			||||
 * devices on the bus.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #1
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; This macro send the string "Marlin" to the slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; It uses multiple M260 commands with one B<base 10> arg
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 A99  ; Target slave address
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B77  ; M
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B97  ; a
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B114 ; r
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B108 ; l
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B105 ; i
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B110 ; n
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 S1   ; Send the current buffer
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #2
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Request 6 bytes from slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * M261 A99 B5
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #3
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example serial output of a M261 request
 | 
				
			||||
 * echo:i2c-reply: from:99 bytes:5 data:hello
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section i2cbus
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXPERIMENTAL_I2CBUS
 | 
				
			||||
#define I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS  0 // Set a value from 8 to 127 to act as a slave
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Add M43, M44 and M45 commands for pins info and testing
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define PINS_DEBUGGING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Auto-report temperatures with M155 S<seconds>
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_REPORT_TEMPERATURES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Include capabilities in M115 output
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTENDED_CAPABILITIES_REPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Double-click the Encoder button on the Status Screen for Z Babystepping.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DOUBLECLICK_FOR_Z_BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#define DOUBLECLICK_MAX_INTERVAL 1250   // Maximum interval between clicks, in milliseconds.
 | 
				
			||||
                                        // Note: You may need to add extra time to mitigate controller latency.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Volumetric extrusion default state
 | 
				
			||||
 * Activate to make volumetric extrusion the default method,
 | 
				
			||||
 * with DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA as the default diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * M200 D0 to disable, M200 Dn to set a new diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VOLUMETRIC_DEFAULT_ON
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this option for a leaner build of Marlin that removes all
 | 
				
			||||
 * workspace offsets, simplifying coordinate transformations, leveling, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - M206 and M428 are disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - G92 will revert to its behavior from Marlin 1.0.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_WORKSPACE_OFFSETS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
@ -1,1500 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings such as:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of electronics
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of temperature sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Printer geometry
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Endstop configuration
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LCD controller
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Extra features
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings can be found in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Getting Started =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Here are some standard links for getting your machine calibrated:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Calibration
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://youtu.be/wAL9d7FgInk
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://calculator.josefprusa.cz
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Triffid_Hunter%27s_Calibration_Guide
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:5573
 | 
				
			||||
 * https://sites.google.com/site/repraplogphase/calibration-of-your-reprap
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:298812
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= DELTA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Delta printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/delta directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= SCARA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Scara printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/SCARA directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section info
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// User-specified version info of this build to display in [Pronterface, etc] terminal window during
 | 
				
			||||
// startup. Implementation of an idea by Prof Braino to inform user that any changes made to this
 | 
				
			||||
// build by the user have been successfully uploaded into firmware.
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_CONFIG_H_AUTHOR "(none, default config)" // Who made the changes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SHOW_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE1 SHORT_BUILD_VERSION // will be shown during bootup in line 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE2 WEBSITE_URL         // will be shown during bootup in line 2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// *** VENDORS PLEASE READ *****************************************************
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin now allow you to have a vendor boot image to be displayed on machine
 | 
				
			||||
// start. When SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN is defined Marlin will first show your
 | 
				
			||||
// custom boot image and then the default Marlin boot image is shown.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// We suggest for you to take advantage of this new feature and keep the Marlin
 | 
				
			||||
// boot image unmodified. For an example have a look at the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
// example configuration folder.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select which serial port on the board will be used for communication with the host.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This allows the connection of wireless adapters (for instance) to non-default port pins.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Serial port 0 is always used by the Arduino bootloader regardless of this setting.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERIAL_PORT 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * This setting determines the communication speed of the printer.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 250000 works in most cases, but you might try a lower speed if
 | 
				
			||||
 * you commonly experience drop-outs during host printing.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[2400, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200, 250000]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define BAUDRATE 250000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable the Bluetooth serial interface on AT90USB devices
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLUETOOTH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The following define selects which electronics board you have.
 | 
				
			||||
// Please choose the name from boards.h that matches your setup
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef MOTHERBOARD
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MOTHERBOARD BOARD_RAMPS_14_EFB
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Optional custom name for your RepStrap or other custom machine
 | 
				
			||||
// Displayed in the LCD "Ready" message
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CUSTOM_MACHINE_NAME "3D Printer"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define this to set a unique identifier for this printer, (Used by some programs to differentiate between machines)
 | 
				
			||||
// You can use an online service to generate a random UUID. (eg http://www.uuidgenerator.net/version4)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MACHINE_UUID "00000000-0000-0000-0000-000000000000"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the number of extruders
 | 
				
			||||
// :[1, 2, 3, 4]
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDERS 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if your E steppers or extruder gear ratios are not identical
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISTINCT_E_FACTORS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Cyclops or any "multi-extruder" that shares a single nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SINGLENOZZLE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual extruder that uses a single stepper motor
 | 
				
			||||
// Don't forget to set SSDE_SERVO_ANGLES and HOTEND_OFFSET_X/Y/Z
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SWITCHING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_ANGLES { 0, 90 } // Angles for E0, E1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Z {0.0, 0.0}
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Mixing Extruder"
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Adds a new code, M165, to set the current mix factors.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Extends the stepping routines to move multiple steppers in proportion to the mix.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Optional support for Repetier Host M163, M164, and virtual extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - This implementation supports only a single extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Enable DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1 for Pia Taubert's reference implementation
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MIXING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MIXING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_STEPPERS 2        // Number of steppers in your mixing extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_VIRTUAL_TOOLS 16  // Use the Virtual Tool method with M163 and M164
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1    // Allow ABCDHI mix factors in G1 movement commands
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Offset of the extruders (uncomment if using more than one and relying on firmware to position when changing).
 | 
				
			||||
// The offset has to be X=0, Y=0 for the extruder 0 hotend (default extruder).
 | 
				
			||||
// For the other hotends it is their distance from the extruder 0 hotend.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_X {0.0, 20.00} // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the X axis
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Y {0.0, 5.00}  // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the Y axis
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select your power supply here. Use 0 if you haven't connected the PS_ON_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 0 = No Power Switch
 | 
				
			||||
 * 1 = ATX
 | 
				
			||||
 * 2 = X-Box 360 203Watts (the blue wire connected to PS_ON and the red wire to VCC)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ 0:'No power switch', 1:'ATX', 2:'X-Box 360' }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define POWER_SUPPLY 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if POWER_SUPPLY > 0
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option to leave the PSU off at startup.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Power to steppers and heaters will need to be turned on with M80.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PS_DEFAULT_OFF
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Thermal Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * --NORMAL IS 4.7kohm PULLUP!-- 1kohm pullup can be used on hotend sensor, using correct resistor and table
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Temperature sensors available:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -3 : thermocouple with MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -2 : thermocouple with MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -1 : thermocouple with AD595
 | 
				
			||||
 *     0 : not used
 | 
				
			||||
 *     1 : 100k thermistor - best choice for EPCOS 100k (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     2 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     3 : Mendel-parts thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     4 : 10k thermistor !! do not use it for a hotend. It gives bad resolution at high temp. !!
 | 
				
			||||
 *     5 : 100K thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     6 : 100k EPCOS - Not as accurate as table 1 (created using a fluke thermocouple) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     7 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAG-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    71 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAF-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     8 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     9 : 100k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    10 : 100k RS thermistor 198-961 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    11 : 100k beta 3950 1% thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    12 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup) (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    13 : 100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend "Simple ONE " & "Hotend "All In ONE"
 | 
				
			||||
 *    20 : the PT100 circuit found in the Ultimainboard V2.x
 | 
				
			||||
 *    60 : 100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950
 | 
				
			||||
 *    66 : 4.7M High Temperature thermistor from Dyze Design
 | 
				
			||||
 *    70 : the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
 *    75 : 100k Generic Silicon Heat Pad with NTC 100K MGB18-104F39050L32 thermistor
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *       1k ohm pullup tables - This is atypical, and requires changing out the 4.7k pullup for 1k.
 | 
				
			||||
 *                              (but gives greater accuracy and more stable PID)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    51 : 100k thermistor - EPCOS (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    52 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    55 : 100k thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1047 : Pt1000 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1010 : Pt1000 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   147 : Pt100 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *   110 : Pt100 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *         Use these for Testing or Development purposes. NEVER for production machine.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   998 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 25°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   999 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 100°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ '0': "Not used", '1':"100k / 4.7k - EPCOS", '2':"200k / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '3':"Mendel-parts / 4.7k", '4':"10k !! do not use for a hotend. Bad resolution at high temp. !!", '5':"100K / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '6':"100k / 4.7k EPCOS - Not as accurate as Table 1", '7':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAG-J01", '8':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT", '9':"100k / 4.7k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1", '10':"100k / 4.7k RS 198-961", '11':"100k / 4.7k beta 3950 1%", '12':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)", '13':"100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend 'Simple ONE ' & hotend 'All In ONE'", '20':"PT100 (Ultimainboard V2.x)", '51':"100k / 1k - EPCOS", '52':"200k / 1k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '55':"100k / 1k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '60':"100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950", '66':"Dyze Design 4.7M High Temperature thermistor", '70':"the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2", '71':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAF-J01", '147':"Pt100 / 4.7k", '1047':"Pt1000 / 4.7k", '110':"Pt100 / 1k (non-standard)", '1010':"Pt1000 / 1k (non standard)", '-3':"Thermocouple + MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)", '-2':"Thermocouple + MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)", '-1':"Thermocouple + AD595",'998':"Dummy 1", '999':"Dummy 2" }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_0 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_1 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_2 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_3 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_BED 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dummy thermistor constant temperature readings, for use with 998 and 999
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_998_VALUE 25
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_999_VALUE 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use temp sensor 1 as a redundant sensor with sensor 0. If the readings
 | 
				
			||||
// from the two sensors differ too much the print will be aborted.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_SENSOR_1_AS_REDUNDANT
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_REDUNDANT_TEMP_SENSOR_DIFF 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder temperature must be close to target for this long before M109 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bed temperature must be close to target for this long before M190 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimal temperature defines the temperature below which the heater will not be enabled It is used
 | 
				
			||||
// to check that the wiring to the thermistor is not broken.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise this would lead to the heater being powered on all the time.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When temperature exceeds max temp, your heater will be switched off.
 | 
				
			||||
// This feature exists to protect your hotend from overheating accidentally, but *NOT* from thermistor short/failure!
 | 
				
			||||
// You should use MINTEMP for thermistor short/failure protection.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MAXTEMP 150
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID Settings ================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// PID Tuning Guide here: http://reprap.org/wiki/PID_Tuning
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Comment the following line to disable PID and enable bang-bang.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#define BANG_MAX 255 // limits current to nozzle while in bang-bang mode; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#define PID_MAX BANG_MAX // limits current to nozzle while PID is active (see PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE below); 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_AUTOTUNE_MENU // Add PID Autotune to the LCD "Temperature" menu to run M303 and apply the result.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_OPENLOOP 1 // Puts PID in open loop. M104/M140 sets the output power from 0 to PID_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SLOW_PWM_HEATERS // PWM with very low frequency (roughly 0.125Hz=8s) and minimum state time of approximately 1s useful for heaters driven by a relay
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_PARAMS_PER_HOTEND // Uses separate PID parameters for each extruder (useful for mismatched extruders)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Set/get with gcode: M301 E[extruder number, 0-2]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE 10 // If the temperature difference between the target temperature and the actual temperature
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // is more than PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE then the PID will be shut off and the heater will be set to min/max.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define K1 0.95 //smoothing factor within the PID
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you are using a pre-configured hotend then you can use one of the value sets by uncommenting it
 | 
				
			||||
  // Ultimaker
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kp 22.2
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Ki 1.08
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kd 114
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // MakerGear
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 7.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 0.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Mendel Parts V9 on 12V
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 63.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 2.25
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 440
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID > Bed Temperature Control ===============
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// Select PID or bang-bang with PIDTEMPBED. If bang-bang, BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING will enable hysteresis
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this to enable PID on the bed. It uses the same frequency PWM as the extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your PID_dT is the default, and correct for your hardware/configuration, that means 7.689Hz,
 | 
				
			||||
// which is fine for driving a square wave into a resistive load and does not significantly impact you FET heating.
 | 
				
			||||
// This also works fine on a Fotek SSR-10DA Solid State Relay into a 250W heater.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your configuration is significantly different than this and you don't understand the issues involved, you probably
 | 
				
			||||
// shouldn't use bed PID until someone else verifies your hardware works.
 | 
				
			||||
// If this is enabled, find your own PID constants below.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This sets the max power delivered to the bed, and replaces the HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER option.
 | 
				
			||||
// all forms of bed control obey this (PID, bang-bang, bang-bang with hysteresis)
 | 
				
			||||
// setting this to anything other than 255 enables a form of PWM to the bed just like HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER did,
 | 
				
			||||
// so you shouldn't use it unless you are OK with PWM on your bed.  (see the comment on enabling PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_BED_POWER 255 // limits duty cycle to bed; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_BED_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from FOPDT model - kp=.39 Tp=405 Tdead=66, Tc set to 79.2, aggressive factor of .15 (vs .1, 1, 10)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKp 10.00
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKi .023
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKd 305.4
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from pidautotune
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKp 97.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKi 1.41
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKd 1675.16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // FIND YOUR OWN: "M303 E-1 C8 S90" to run autotune on the bed at 90 degreesC for 8 cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents extrusion if the temperature is below EXTRUDE_MINTEMP.
 | 
				
			||||
// It also enables the M302 command to set the minimum extrusion temperature
 | 
				
			||||
// or to allow moving the extruder regardless of the hotend temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// *** IT IS HIGHLY RECOMMENDED TO LEAVE THIS OPTION ENABLED! ***
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_COLD_EXTRUSION
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MINTEMP 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents a single extrusion longer than EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH.
 | 
				
			||||
// Note that for Bowden Extruders a too-small value here may prevent loading.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_LENGTHY_EXTRUDE
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH 200
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//======================== Thermal Runaway Protection =======================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get "Thermal Runaway" or "Heating failed" errors the
 | 
				
			||||
 * details can be tuned in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS // Enable thermal protection for all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED     // Enable thermal protection for the heated bed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Mechanical Settings =========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment one of these options to enable CoreXY, CoreXZ, or CoreYZ kinematics
 | 
				
			||||
// either in the usual order or reversed
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXY
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option for Toshiba steppers
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CONFIG_STEPPERS_TOSHIBA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Endstop Settings ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Specify here all the endstop connectors that are connected to any endstop or probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// Almost all printers will be using one per axis. Probes will use one or more of the
 | 
				
			||||
// extra connectors. Leave undefined any used for non-endstop and non-probe purposes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_XMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_YMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_ZMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_XMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_YMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_ZMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// coarse Endstop Settings
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENDSTOPPULLUPS // Comment this out (using // at the start of the line) to disable the endstop pullup resistors
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(ENDSTOPPULLUPS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // fine endstop settings: Individual pullups. will be ignored if ENDSTOPPULLUPS is defined
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Mechanical endstop with COM to ground and NC to Signal uses "false" here (most common setup).
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the probe.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this feature if all enabled endstop pins are interrupt-capable.
 | 
				
			||||
// This will remove the need to poll the interrupt pins, saving many CPU cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOP_INTERRUPTS_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Movement Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section motion
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Settings
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * These settings can be reset by M502
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You can set distinct factors for each E stepper, if needed.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If fewer factors are given, the last will apply to the rest.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note that if EEPROM is enabled, saved values will override these.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Axis Steps Per Unit (steps/mm)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M92
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_AXIS_STEPS_PER_UNIT   { 80, 80, 4000, 500 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Feed Rate (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M203
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_FEEDRATE          { 300, 300, 5, 25 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * (Maximum start speed for accelerated moves)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M201
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_ACCELERATION      { 3000, 3000, 100, 10000 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M204
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 P    Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 R    Retract Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 T    Travel Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ACCELERATION          3000    // X, Y, Z and E acceleration for printing moves
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_RETRACT_ACCELERATION  3000    // E acceleration for retracts
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_TRAVEL_ACCELERATION   3000    // X, Y, Z acceleration for travel (non printing) moves
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Jerk (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M205 X Y Z E
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Jerk" specifies the minimum speed change that requires acceleration.
 | 
				
			||||
 * When changing speed and direction, if the difference is less than the
 | 
				
			||||
 * value set here, it may happen instantaneously.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_XJERK                 20.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_YJERK                 20.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ZJERK                  0.4
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_EJERK                  5.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Z Probe Options =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section probes
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Probe Type
 | 
				
			||||
// Probes are sensors/switches that are activated / deactivated before/after use.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probes, Servo Probes, Z-Sled Probes, FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
// You must activate one of these to use Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use M851 to set the Z probe vertical offset from the nozzle. Store with M500.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A Fix-Mounted Probe either doesn't deploy or needs manual deployment.
 | 
				
			||||
// For example an inductive probe, or a setup that uses the nozzle to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// An inductive probe must be deactivated to go below
 | 
				
			||||
// its trigger-point if hardware endstops are active.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The BLTouch probe emulates a servo probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// The default connector is SERVO 0. Set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR below to override.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLTOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Servo Probe, such as an endstop switch on a rotating arm.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_SERVO_ANGLES {70,0} // Z Servo Deploy and Stow angles
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if you have a Z probe mounted on a sled like those designed by Charles Bell.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_SLED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SLED_DOCKING_OFFSET 5 // The extra distance the X axis must travel to pickup the sled. 0 should be fine but you can push it further if you'd like.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Probe to nozzle (X,Y) offset, relative to (0, 0).
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y offsets must be integers.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In the following example the X and Y offsets are both positive:
 | 
				
			||||
// #define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
// #define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    +-- BACK ---+
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//  L |    (+) P  | R <-- probe (20,20)
 | 
				
			||||
//  E |           | I
 | 
				
			||||
//  F | (-) N (+) | G <-- nozzle (10,10)
 | 
				
			||||
//  T |           | H
 | 
				
			||||
//    |    (-)    | T
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//    O-- FRONT --+
 | 
				
			||||
//  (0,0)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10  // X offset: -left  +right  [of the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10  // Y offset: -front +behind [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 0   // Z offset: -below +above  [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y axis travel speed (mm/m) between probes
 | 
				
			||||
#define XY_PROBE_SPEED 8000
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the first approach when double-probing (with PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH)
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the "accurate" probe of each point
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_SLOW (Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST / 2)
 | 
				
			||||
// Use double touch for probing
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probe is defined in the Delta example configurations.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// *** PLEASE READ ALL INSTRUCTIONS BELOW FOR SAFETY! ***
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To continue using the Z-min-endstop for homing, be sure to disable Z_SAFE_HOMING.
 | 
				
			||||
// Example: To park the head outside the bed area when homing with G28.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a separate Z probe, your board must define a Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For a servo-based Z probe, just set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR and Z_SERVO_ANGLES above.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - RAMPS 1.3/1.4 boards may be able to use the 5V, GND, and Aux4->D32 pin.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Use 5V for powered (usu. inductive) sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Otherwise connect:
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-closed switches to GND and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-open switches to 5V and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Normally-closed switches are advised and are the default.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN sets the Arduino pin to use. (See your board's pins file.)
 | 
				
			||||
// Since the RAMPS Aux4->D32 pin maps directly to the Arduino D32 pin, D32 is the
 | 
				
			||||
// default pin for all RAMPS-based boards. Most boards use the X_MAX_PIN by default.
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a different pin you can override it here.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING:
 | 
				
			||||
// Setting the wrong pin may have unexpected and potentially disastrous consequences.
 | 
				
			||||
// Use with caution and do your homework.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN X_MAX_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP to use _both_ a Z Probe and a Z-min-endstop on the same machine.
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option the Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN will only be used for probing, never for homing.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN to use the Z_MIN_PIN for your Z_MIN_PROBE.
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PIN will then be used for both Z-homing and probing.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a probe you must enable one of the two options above!
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z Probe Repeatability test to see how accurate your probe is
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_REPEATABILITY_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Z probes require clearance when deploying, stowing, and moving between
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe points to avoid hitting the bed and other hardware.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Servo-mounted probes require extra space for the arm to rotate.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Inductive probes need space to keep from triggering early.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use these settings to specify the distance (mm) to raise the probe (or
 | 
				
			||||
 * lower the bed). The values set here apply over and above any (negative)
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe Z Offset set with Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER, M851, or the LCD.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only integer values >= 1 are valid here.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Example: `M851 Z-5` with a CLEARANCE of 4  =>  9mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     But: `M851 Z+1` with a CLEARANCE of 2  =>  2mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_DEPLOY_PROBE   10 // Z Clearance for Deploy/Stow
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_BETWEEN_PROBES  5 // Z Clearance between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For M851 give a range for adjusting the Z probe offset
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MIN -20
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MAX 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Inverting Stepper Enable Pins (Active Low) use 0, Non Inverting (Active High) use 1
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 0:'Low', 1:'High' }
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define E_ENABLE_ON 0 // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Disables axis stepper immediately when it's not being used.
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING: When motors turn off there is a chance of losing position accuracy!
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_X false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Y false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Z false
 | 
				
			||||
// Warn on display about possibly reduced accuracy
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISABLE_REDUCED_ACCURACY_WARNING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_E false // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_EXTRUDER true //disable only inactive extruders and keep active extruder enabled
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Invert the stepper direction. Change (or reverse the motor connector) if an axis goes the wrong way.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For direct drive extruder v9 set to true, for geared extruder set to false.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E0_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E1_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E2_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E3_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_HOMING_HEIGHT 4  // (in mm) Minimal z height before homing (G28) for Z clearance above the bed, clamps, ...
 | 
				
			||||
                             // Be sure you have this distance over your Z_MAX_POS in case.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Direction of endstops when homing; 1=MAX, -1=MIN
 | 
				
			||||
// :[-1,1]
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Travel limits after homing (units are in mm)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move below MIN_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MIN_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move above MAX_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Runout Sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * A mechanical or opto endstop is used to check for the presence of filament.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * RAMPS-based boards use SERVO3_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * For other boards you may need to define FIL_RUNOUT_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * By default the firmware assumes HIGH = has filament, LOW = ran out
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FIL_RUNOUT_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the sensor.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENDSTOPPULLUP_FIL_RUNOUT // Uncomment to use internal pullup for filament runout pins if the sensor is defined.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT "M600"
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Bed Leveling ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section bedlevel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select one form of Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  If you're also using the Probe for Z Homing, it's
 | 
				
			||||
 *  highly recommended to enable Z_SAFE_HOMING also!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - 3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe 3 arbitrary points on the bed (that aren't collinear)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the XY coordinates of all 3 points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a mesh, best for large or uneven beds.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - UBL Unified Bed Leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 *   A comprehensive bed leveling system that combines features and benefits from previous
 | 
				
			||||
 *   bed leveling system.  The UBL Bed Leveling System also includes an integrated and easy to use
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Mesh Generation, Mesh Validation and Mesh Editing system.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     - Currently, the UBL Bed Leveling System is only checked out for Cartesian Printers.  But with
 | 
				
			||||
 *       that said, it was primarily designed to handle poor quality Delta Printers.  If you feel
 | 
				
			||||
 *       adventurous and have a Delta, please post an issue if something doesn't work correctly.
 | 
				
			||||
 *       Initially, you will need to reduce your declared bed size so you have a rectangular area to
 | 
				
			||||
 *       test on.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MESH_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable detailed logging of G28, G29, M48, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Turn on with the command 'M111 S32'.
 | 
				
			||||
 * NOTE: Requires a lot of PROGMEM!
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DEBUG_LEVELING_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Gradually reduce leveling correction until a set height is reached,
 | 
				
			||||
  // at which point movement will be level to the machine's XY plane.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The height can be set with M420 Z<height>
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENABLE_LEVELING_FADE_HEIGHT
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the number of grid points per dimension.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X 3
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_Y ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the boundaries for probing (where the probe can reach).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LEFT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RIGHT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FRONT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BACK_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // The Z probe minimum outer margin (to validate G29 parameters).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_PROBE_EDGE 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Probe along the Y axis, advancing X after each column
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PROBE_Y_FIRST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    // Experimental Subdivision of the grid by Catmull-Rom method.
 | 
				
			||||
    // Synthesizes intermediate points to produce a more detailed mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION
 | 
				
			||||
    #if ENABLED(ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION)
 | 
				
			||||
      // Number of subdivisions between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
      #define BILINEAR_SUBDIVISIONS 3
 | 
				
			||||
    #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // 3 arbitrary points to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
  // A simple cross-product is used to estimate the plane of the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_X 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 180
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_X 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_X 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=================================== Mesh ==================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_PROBE_Z_RANGE 4 // Z after Home, bed somewhere below but above 0.0.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_INSET 10          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 3    // Don't use more than 7 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MESH_G28_REST_ORIGIN // After homing all axes ('G28' or 'G28 XYZ') rest at origin [0,0,0]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MANUAL_BED_LEVELING  // Add display menu option for bed leveling.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(MANUAL_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define MBL_Z_STEP 0.025     // Step size while manually probing Z axis.
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif  // MANUAL_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//========================= Unified Bed Leveling ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_INSET 1          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 10  // Don't use more than 15 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 10
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_X 39       // These set the probe locations for when UBL does a 3-Point leveling
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 180      // of the mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_X 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_X 180
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif  // BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Commands to execute at the end of G29 probing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Useful to retract or move the Z probe out of the way.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_END_SCRIPT "G1 Z10 F12000\nG1 X15 Y330\nG1 Z0.5\nG1 Z10"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The center of the bed is at (X=0, Y=0)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_CENTER_AT_0_0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Manually set the home position. Leave these undefined for automatic settings.
 | 
				
			||||
// For DELTA this is the top-center of the Cartesian print volume.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_X_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_Y_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_Z_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use "Z Safe Homing" to avoid homing with a Z probe outside the bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this feature enabled:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - Allow Z homing only after X and Y homing AND stepper drivers still enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// - If stepper drivers time out, it will need X and Y homing again before Z homing.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Move the Z probe (or nozzle) to a defined XY point before Z Homing when homing all axes (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
// - Prevent Z homing when the Z probe is outside bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_SAFE_HOMING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_SAFE_HOMING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_X_POINT ((X_MIN_POS + X_MAX_POS) / 2)    // X point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_Y_POINT ((Y_MIN_POS + Y_MAX_POS) / 2)    // Y point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Homing speeds (mm/m)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_XY (50*60)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z  (4*60)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Additional Features ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The microcontroller can store settings in the EEPROM, e.g. max velocity...
 | 
				
			||||
// M500 - stores parameters in EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
// M501 - reads parameters from EEPROM (if you need reset them after you changed them temporarily).
 | 
				
			||||
// M502 - reverts to the default "factory settings".  You still need to store them in EEPROM afterwards if you want to.
 | 
				
			||||
//define this to enable EEPROM support
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EEPROM_SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EEPROM_SETTINGS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // To disable EEPROM Serial responses and decrease program space by ~1700 byte: comment this out:
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EEPROM_CHITCHAT // Please keep turned on if you can.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Host Keepalive
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will send a busy status message to the host
 | 
				
			||||
// every couple of seconds when it can't accept commands.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOST_KEEPALIVE_FEATURE        // Disable this if your host doesn't like keepalive messages
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_KEEPALIVE_INTERVAL 2  // Number of seconds between "busy" messages. Set with M113.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M100 Free Memory Watcher
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define M100_FREE_MEMORY_WATCHER // uncomment to add the M100 Free Memory Watcher for debug purpose
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// G20/G21 Inch mode support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INCH_MODE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M149 Set temperature units support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMPERATURE_UNITS_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Preheat Constants
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_HOTEND 180
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_BED     70
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_HOTEND 240
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_BED    110
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Nozzle Park -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to define a special XYZ position, inside the
 | 
				
			||||
// machine's topology, to park the nozzle when idle or when receiving the G27
 | 
				
			||||
// command.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The "P" paramenter controls what is the action applied to the Z axis:
 | 
				
			||||
//    P0: (Default) If current Z-pos is lower than Z-park then the nozzle will
 | 
				
			||||
//        be raised to reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P1: No matter the current Z-pos, the nozzle will be raised/lowered to
 | 
				
			||||
//        reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P2: The nozzle height will be raised by Z-park amount but never going over
 | 
				
			||||
//        the machine's limit of Z_MAX_POS.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify a park position as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_PARK_POINT { (X_MIN_POS + 10), (Y_MAX_POS - 10), 20 }
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Clean Nozzle Feature -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to send G12 to start the nozzle cleaning
 | 
				
			||||
// process, the G-Code accepts two parameters:
 | 
				
			||||
//   "P" for pattern selection
 | 
				
			||||
//   "S" for defining the number of strokes/repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Available list of patterns:
 | 
				
			||||
//   P0: This is the default pattern, this process requires a sponge type
 | 
				
			||||
//       material at a fixed bed location. S defines "strokes" i.e.
 | 
				
			||||
//       back-and-forth movements between the starting and end points.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P1: This starts a zig-zag pattern between (X0, Y0) and (X1, Y1), "T"
 | 
				
			||||
//       defines the number of zig-zag triangles to be done. "S" defines the
 | 
				
			||||
//       number of strokes aka one back-and-forth movement. Zig-zags will
 | 
				
			||||
//       be performed in whichever dimension is smallest. As an example,
 | 
				
			||||
//       sending "G12 P1 S1 T3" will execute:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//          --
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y1) |     /\        /\        /\     | (X1, Y1)
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |    /  \      /  \      /  \    |
 | 
				
			||||
//       A |           |   /    \    /    \    /    \   |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |  /      \  /      \  /      \  |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y0) | /        \/        \/        \ | (X1, Y0)
 | 
				
			||||
//          --         +--------------------------------+
 | 
				
			||||
//                       |________|_________|_________|
 | 
				
			||||
//                           T1        T2        T3
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P2: This starts a circular pattern with circle with middle in
 | 
				
			||||
//       NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE radius of R and stroke count of S.
 | 
				
			||||
//       Before starting the circle nozzle goes to NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Caveats: End point Z should use the same value as Start point Z.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Attention: This is an EXPERIMENTAL feature, in the future the G-code arguments
 | 
				
			||||
// may change to add new functionality like different wipe patterns.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of pattern repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_STROKES  12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of triangles
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_TRIANGLES  3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify positions as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT { 30, 30, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_END_POINT   {100, 60, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern radius
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_RADIUS 6.5
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern circle fragments number
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_FN 10
 | 
				
			||||
  // Middle point of circle
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Moves the nozzle to the initial position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_GOBACK
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option to automatically start and stop the
 | 
				
			||||
// print job timer when M104/M109/M190 commands are received.
 | 
				
			||||
// M104 (extruder without wait) - high temp = none, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M109 (extruder with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M190 (bed with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = none
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In all cases the timer can be started and stopped using
 | 
				
			||||
// the following commands:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - M75  - Start the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M76  - Pause the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M77  - Stop the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
#define PRINTJOB_TIMER_AUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print Counter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will keep track of some print statistical data such as:
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total successful print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total failed print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total time printing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This information can be viewed by the M78 command.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PRINTCOUNTER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= LCD and SD support ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD LANGUAGE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Here you may choose the language used by Marlin on the LCD menus, the following
 | 
				
			||||
// list of languages are available:
 | 
				
			||||
//    en, an, bg, ca, cn, cz, de, el, el-gr, es, eu, fi, fr, gl, hr, it,
 | 
				
			||||
//    kana, kana_utf8, nl, pl, pt, pt_utf8, pt-br, pt-br_utf8, ru, tr, uk, test
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 'en':'English', 'an':'Aragonese', 'bg':'Bulgarian', 'ca':'Catalan', 'cn':'Chinese', 'cz':'Czech', 'de':'German', 'el':'Greek', 'el-gr':'Greek (Greece)', 'es':'Spanish', 'eu':'Basque-Euskera', 'fi':'Finnish', 'fr':'French', 'gl':'Galician', 'hr':'Croatian', 'it':'Italian', 'kana':'Japanese', 'kana_utf8':'Japanese (UTF8)', 'nl':'Dutch', 'pl':'Polish', 'pt':'Portuguese', 'pt-br':'Portuguese (Brazilian)', 'pt-br_utf8':'Portuguese (Brazilian UTF8)', 'pt_utf8':'Portuguese (UTF8)', 'ru':'Russian', 'tr':'Turkish', 'uk':'Ukrainian', 'test':'TEST' }
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define LCD_LANGUAGE en
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD Character Set
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This option is NOT applicable to Graphical Displays.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// All character-based LCD's provide ASCII plus one of these
 | 
				
			||||
// language extensions:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - JAPANESE ... the most common
 | 
				
			||||
//  - WESTERN  ... with more accented characters
 | 
				
			||||
//  - CYRILLIC ... for the Russian language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To determine the language extension installed on your controller:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Compile and upload with LCD_LANGUAGE set to 'test'
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Click the controller to view the LCD menu
 | 
				
			||||
//  - The LCD will display Japanese, Western, or Cyrillic text
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// See https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin/wiki/LCD-Language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :['JAPANESE', 'WESTERN', 'CYRILLIC']
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISPLAY_CHARSET_HD44780 JAPANESE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD TYPE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// You may choose ULTRA_LCD if you have character based LCD with 16x2, 16x4, 20x2,
 | 
				
			||||
// 20x4 char/lines or DOGLCD for the full graphics display with 128x64 pixels
 | 
				
			||||
// (ST7565R family). (This option will be set automatically for certain displays.)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// IMPORTANT NOTE: The U8glib library is required for Full Graphic Display!
 | 
				
			||||
//                 https://github.com/olikraus/U8glib_Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTRA_LCD   // Character based
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DOGLCD      // Full graphics display
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD Card support is disabled by default. If your controller has an SD slot,
 | 
				
			||||
// you must uncomment the following option or it won't work.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: SPI SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment ONE of the following items to use a slower SPI transfer
 | 
				
			||||
// speed. This is usually required if you're getting volume init errors.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_HALF_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_QUARTER_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_EIGHTH_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: ENABLE CRC
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use CRC checks and retries on the SD communication.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SD_CHECK_AND_RETRY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ENCODER SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option overrides the default number of encoder pulses needed to
 | 
				
			||||
// produce one step. Should be increased for high-resolution encoders.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_PULSES_PER_STEP 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use this option to override the number of step signals required to
 | 
				
			||||
// move between next/prev menu items.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_STEPS_PER_MENU_ITEM 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Encoder Direction Options
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Test your encoder's behavior first with both options disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Edit and Menu Nav? Enable REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Menu Navigation only?    Enable REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Editing only?      Enable BOTH options.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction everywhere
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  Set this option if CLOCKWISE causes values to DECREASE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction for navigating LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves DOWN this makes it go UP.
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves UP this makes it go DOWN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Individual Axis Homing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Add individual axis homing items (Home X, Home Y, and Home Z) to the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INDIVIDUAL_AXIS_HOMING_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SPEAKER/BUZZER
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you have a speaker that can produce tones, enable it here.
 | 
				
			||||
// By default Marlin assumes you have a buzzer with a fixed frequency.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPEAKER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The duration and frequency for the UI feedback sound.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set these to 0 to disable audio feedback in the LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Test audio output with the G-Code:
 | 
				
			||||
//  M300 S<frequency Hz> P<duration ms>
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_DURATION_MS 100
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_HZ 1000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Standard
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin supports a wide variety of controllers.
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable one of the following options to specify your controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIMAKER Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIMAKERCONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIPANEL as seen on Thingiverse.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Cartesio UI
 | 
				
			||||
// http://mauk.cc/webshop/cartesio-shop/electronics/user-interface
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CARTESIO_UI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PanelOne from T3P3 (via RAMPS 1.4 AUX2/AUX3)
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/PanelOne
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PANEL_ONE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MaKr3d Makr-Panel with graphic controller and SD support.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/MaKr3d_MaKrPanel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAKRPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ReprapWorld Graphical LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// https://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id/1218
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_GRAPHICAL_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Activate one of these if you have a Panucatt Devices
 | 
				
			||||
// Viki 2.0 or mini Viki with Graphic LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// http://panucatt.com
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VIKI2
 | 
				
			||||
//#define miniVIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Adafruit ST7565 Full Graphic Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// https://github.com/eboston/Adafruit-ST7565-Full-Graphic-Controller/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount Smart Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a white PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// GADGETS3D G3D LCD/SD Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RAMPS_1.3/1.4_GADGETS3D_Shield_with_Panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a blue PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G3D_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount FULL GRAPHIC Smart Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Full_Graphic_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_FULL_GRAPHIC_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MakerLab Mini Panel with graphic
 | 
				
			||||
// controller and SD support - http://reprap.org/wiki/Mini_panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MINIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapWorld REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD v1.1
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id=202&cPath=1591_1626
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP sets how much should the robot move when a key
 | 
				
			||||
// is pressed, a value of 10.0 means 10mm per click.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP 1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RigidBot Panel V1.0
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.inventapart.com/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RIGIDBOT_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// BQ LCD Smart Controller shipped by
 | 
				
			||||
// default with the BQ Hephestos 2 and Witbox 2.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BQ_LCD_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: These controllers require the installation of Arduino's LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// library. For more info: https://github.com/kiyoshigawa/LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Elefu RA Board Control Panel
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.elefu.com/index.php?route=product/product&product_id=53
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RA_CONTROL_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Sainsmart YW Robot (LCM1602) LCD Display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_SAINSMART_YWROBOT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Generic LCM1602 LCD adapter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCM1602
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PANELOLU2 LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// separate encoder and click inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This controller requires Arduino's LiquidTWI2 library v1.2.3 or later.
 | 
				
			||||
// For more info: https://github.com/lincomatic/LiquidTWI2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: The PANELOLU2 encoder click input can either be directly connected to
 | 
				
			||||
// a pin (if BTN_ENC defined to != -1) or read through I2C (when BTN_ENC == -1).
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_PANELOLU2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Panucatt VIKI LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// integrated click & L/R/U/D buttons, separate encoder inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_VIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SSD1306 OLED full graphics generic display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SAV OLEd LCD module support using either SSD1306 or SH1106 based LCD modules
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SAV_3DGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
  #define U8GLIB_SH1106
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Shift register panels
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// 2 wire Non-latching LCD SR from https://goo.gl/aJJ4sH
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD configuration: http://reprap.org/wiki/SAV_3D_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Extra Features ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Increase the FAN PWM frequency. Removes the PWM noise but increases heating in the FET/Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAST_PWM_FAN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use software PWM to drive the fan, as for the heaters. This uses a very low frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// which is not as annoying as with the hardware PWM. On the other hand, if this frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// is too low, you should also increment SOFT_PWM_SCALE.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_SOFT_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Incrementing this by 1 will double the software PWM frequency,
 | 
				
			||||
// affecting heaters, and the fan if FAN_SOFT_PWM is enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// However, control resolution will be halved for each increment;
 | 
				
			||||
// at zero value, there are 128 effective control positions.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SOFT_PWM_SCALE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Temperature status LEDs that display the hotend and bed temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// If all hotends and bed temperature and temperature setpoint are < 54C then the BLUE led is on.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise the RED led is on. There is 1C hysteresis.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_STAT_LEDS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// M240  Triggers a camera by emulating a Canon RC-1 Remote
 | 
				
			||||
// Data from: http://www.doc-diy.net/photo/rc-1_hacked/
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PHOTOGRAPH_PIN     23
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// SkeinForge sends the wrong arc g-codes when using Arc Point as fillet procedure
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SF_ARC_FIX
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for the BariCUDA Paste Extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BARICUDA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//define BlinkM/CyzRgb Support
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLINKM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for an RGB LED using 3 separate pins with optional PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RGB_LED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(RGB_LED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_R_PIN 34
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_G_PIN 43
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_B_PIN 35
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/*********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
* R/C SERVO support
 | 
				
			||||
* Sponsored by TrinityLabs, Reworked by codexmas
 | 
				
			||||
**********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of servos
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you select a configuration below, this will receive a default value and does not need to be set manually
 | 
				
			||||
// set it manually if you have more servos than extruders and wish to manually control some
 | 
				
			||||
// leaving it undefined or defining as 0 will disable the servo subsystem
 | 
				
			||||
// If unsure, leave commented / disabled
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NUM_SERVOS 3 // Servo index starts with 0 for M280 command
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Delay (in milliseconds) before the next move will start, to give the servo time to reach its target angle.
 | 
				
			||||
// 300ms is a good value but you can try less delay.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the servo can't reach the requested position, increase it.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERVO_DELAY 300
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Servo deactivation
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option servos are powered only during movement, then turned off to prevent jitter.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DEACTIVATE_SERVOS_AFTER_MOVE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
 * Support for a filament diameter sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also allows adjustment of diameter at print time (vs  at slicing)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Single extruder only at this point (extruder 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 * 34 - RAMPS1.4 - uses Analog input 5 on the AUX2 connector
 | 
				
			||||
 * 81 - Printrboard - Uses Analog input 2 on the Exp1 connector (version B,C,D,E)
 | 
				
			||||
 * 301 - Rambo  - uses Analog input 3
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note may require analog pins to be defined for different motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 **********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment below to enable
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA 3.00  //Enter the diameter (in mm) of the filament generally used (3.0 mm or 1.75 mm) - this is then used in the slicer software.  Used for sensor reading validation
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_SENSOR_EXTRUDER_NUM 0   //The number of the extruder that has the filament sensor (0,1,2)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM        14   //measurement delay in cm.  This is the distance from filament sensor to middle of barrel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_UPPER_LIMIT         3.30  //upper limit factor used for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_LOWER_LIMIT         1.90  //lower limit factor for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MAX_MEASUREMENT_DELAY       20     //delay buffer size in bytes (1 byte = 1cm)- limits maximum measurement delay allowable (must be larger than MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM  and lower number saves RAM)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_MEASURED_FILAMENT_DIA  DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA  //set measured to nominal initially
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //When using an LCD, uncomment the line below to display the Filament sensor data on the last line instead of status.  Status will appear for 5 sec.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define FILAMENT_LCD_DISPLAY
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
@ -1,1085 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only change these if you know exactly what you're doing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these settings can damage your printer if improperly set!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings can be found in Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Thermal Settings  ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BED_CHECK_INTERVAL 5000 // ms between checks in bang-bang control
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Only disable heating if T>target+BED_HYSTERESIS and enable heating if T>target-BED_HYSTERESIS
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The solution: Once the temperature reaches the target, start observing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If the temperature stays too far below the target (hysteresis) for too long (period),
 | 
				
			||||
 * the firmware will halt the machine as a safety precaution.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get false positives for "Thermal Runaway" increase THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS and/or THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD 40        // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS 4     // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M104 or M109 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M104/M109,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get false positives for "Heating failed" increase WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD 20                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection parameters for the bed are just as above for hotends.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_PERIOD 20    // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M140 or M190 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M140/M190,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get too many "Heating failed" errors, increase WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE. (WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD 60                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  // this adds an experimental additional term to the heating power, proportional to the extrusion speed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if Kc is chosen well, the additional required power due to increased melting should be compensated.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define DEFAULT_Kc (100) //heating power=Kc*(e_speed)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define LPQ_MAX_LEN 50
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Automatic Temperature:
 | 
				
			||||
 * The hotend target temperature is calculated by all the buffered lines of gcode.
 | 
				
			||||
 * The maximum buffered steps/sec of the extruder motor is called "se".
 | 
				
			||||
 * Start autotemp mode with M109 S<mintemp> B<maxtemp> F<factor>
 | 
				
			||||
 * The target temperature is set to mintemp+factor*se[steps/sec] and is limited by
 | 
				
			||||
 * mintemp and maxtemp. Turn this off by executing M109 without F*
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also, if the temperature is set to a value below mintemp, it will not be changed by autotemp.
 | 
				
			||||
 * On an Ultimaker, some initial testing worked with M109 S215 B260 F1 in the start.gcode
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define AUTOTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTOTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTOTEMP_OLDWEIGHT 0.98
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//Show Temperature ADC value
 | 
				
			||||
//The M105 command return, besides traditional information, the ADC value read from temperature sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_TEMP_ADC_VALUES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * High Temperature Thermistor Support
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermistors able to support high temperature tend to have a hard time getting
 | 
				
			||||
 * good readings at room and lower temperatures. This means HEATER_X_RAW_LO_TEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 * will probably be caught when the heating element first turns on during the
 | 
				
			||||
 * preheating process, which will trigger a min_temp_error as a safety measure
 | 
				
			||||
 * and force stop everything.
 | 
				
			||||
 * To circumvent this limitation, we allow for a preheat time (during which,
 | 
				
			||||
 * min_temp_error won't be triggered) and add a min_temp buffer to handle
 | 
				
			||||
 * aberrant readings.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you want to enable this feature for your hotend thermistor(s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * uncomment and set values > 0 in the constants below
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of consecutive low temperature errors that can occur
 | 
				
			||||
// before a min_temp_error is triggered. (Shouldn't be more than 10.)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAX_CONSECUTIVE_LOW_TEMPERATURE_ERROR_ALLOWED 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of milliseconds a hotend will preheat before starting to check
 | 
				
			||||
// the temperature. This value should NOT be set to the time it takes the
 | 
				
			||||
// hot end to reach the target temperature, but the time it takes to reach
 | 
				
			||||
// the minimum temperature your thermistor can read. The lower the better/safer.
 | 
				
			||||
// This shouldn't need to be more than 30 seconds (30000)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MILLISECONDS_PREHEAT_TIME 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder runout prevention.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the machine is idle and the temperature over MINTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
// then extrude some filament every couple of SECONDS.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_MINTEMP 190
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SECONDS 30
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SPEED 1500  // mm/m
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_EXTRUDE 5   // mm
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//These defines help to calibrate the AD595 sensor in case you get wrong temperature measurements.
 | 
				
			||||
//The measured temperature is defined as "actualTemp = (measuredTemp * TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN) + TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET"
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET 0.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN   1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//This is for controlling a fan to cool down the stepper drivers
 | 
				
			||||
//it will turn on when any driver is enabled
 | 
				
			||||
//and turn off after the set amount of seconds from last driver being disabled again
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_PIN -1 //Pin used for the fan to cool controller (-1 to disable)
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SECS 60 //How many seconds, after all motors were disabled, the fan should run
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SPEED 255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When first starting the main fan, run it at full speed for the
 | 
				
			||||
// given number of milliseconds.  This gets the fan spinning reliably
 | 
				
			||||
// before setting a PWM value. (Does not work with software PWM for fan on Sanguinololu)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_KICKSTART_TIME 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the minimal speed for the main fan, run in PWM mode
 | 
				
			||||
// to enable uncomment and set minimal PWM speed for reliable running (1-255)
 | 
				
			||||
// if fan speed is [1 - (FAN_MIN_PWM-1)] it is set to FAN_MIN_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_MIN_PWM 50
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder cooling fans
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder auto fans automatically turn on when their extruders'
 | 
				
			||||
 * temperatures go above EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Your board's pins file specifies the recommended pins. Override those here
 | 
				
			||||
 * or set to -1 to disable completely.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Multiple extruders can be assigned to the same pin in which case
 | 
				
			||||
 * the fan will turn on when any selected extruder is above the threshold.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define E0_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E1_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E2_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E3_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE 50
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_SPEED   255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define a pin to turn case light on/off
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CASE_LIGHT_PIN 4
 | 
				
			||||
#if PIN_EXISTS(CASE_LIGHT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_CASE_LIGHT false   // Set to true if HIGH is the OFF state (active low)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define CASE_LIGHT_DEFAULT_ON   // Uncomment to set default state to on
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ITEM_CASE_LIGHT    // Uncomment to have a Case Light On / Off entry in main menu
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================ Mechanical Settings ==========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If you want endstops to stay on (by default) even when not homing
 | 
				
			||||
// enable this option. Override at any time with M120, M121.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOPS_ALWAYS_ON_DEFAULT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_LATE_ENABLE // Enable Z the last moment. Needed if your Z driver overheats.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual X Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two X axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second X stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two X motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_X2_VS_X_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual Y Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two Y axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Y stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two Y motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_Y2_VS_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A single Z stepper driver is usually used to drive 2 stepper motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to use a separate stepper driver for each Z axis motor.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Z stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS is a feature to enable the use of 2 endstops for both Z steppers - Let's call them Z stepper and Z2 stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
  // That way the machine is capable to align the bed during home, since both Z steppers are homed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // There is also an implementation of M666 (software endstops adjustment) to this feature.
 | 
				
			||||
  // After Z homing, this adjustment is applied to just one of the steppers in order to align the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // One just need to home the Z axis and measure the distance difference between both Z axis and apply the math: Z adjust = Z - Z2.
 | 
				
			||||
  // If the Z stepper axis is closer to the bed, the measure Z > Z2 (yes, it is.. think about it) and the Z adjust would be positive.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Play a little bit with small adjustments (0.5mm) and check the behaviour.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The M119 (endstops report) will start reporting the Z2 Endstop as well.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define Z2_USE_ENDSTOP _XMAX_
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this for dual x-carriage printers.
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual x-carriage design has the advantage that the inactive extruder can be parked which
 | 
				
			||||
// prevents hot-end ooze contaminating the print. It also reduces the weight of each x-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
// allowing faster printing speeds. Connect your X2 stepper to the first unused E plug.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DUAL_X_CARRIAGE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Configuration for second X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: the first x-carriage is defined as the x-carriage which homes to the minimum endstop;
 | 
				
			||||
  // the second x-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MIN_POS 80     // set minimum to ensure second x-carriage doesn't hit the parked first X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_POS 353    // set maximum to the distance between toolheads when both heads are homed
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_DIR 1     // the second X-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_POS X2_MAX_POS // default home position is the maximum carriage position
 | 
				
			||||
      // However: In this mode the HOTEND_OFFSET_X value for the second extruder provides a software
 | 
				
			||||
      // override for X2_HOME_POS. This also allow recalibration of the distance between the two endstops
 | 
				
			||||
      // without modifying the firmware (through the "M218 T1 X???" command).
 | 
				
			||||
      // Remember: you should set the second extruder x-offset to 0 in your slicer.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // There are a few selectable movement modes for dual x-carriages using M605 S<mode>
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 0 (DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE): Full control. The slicer has full control over both x-carriages and can achieve optimal travel results
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    as long as it supports dual x-carriages. (M605 S0)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 1 (DXC_AUTO_PARK_MODE)   : Auto-park mode. The firmware will automatically park and unpark the x-carriages on tool changes so
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    that additional slicer support is not required. (M605 S1)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 2 (DXC_DUPLICATION_MODE) : Duplication mode. The firmware will transparently make the second x-carriage and extruder copy all
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    actions of the first x-carriage. This allows the printer to print 2 arbitrary items at
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    once. (2nd extruder x offset and temp offset are set using: M605 S2 [Xnnn] [Rmmm])
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This is the default power-up mode which can be later using M605.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUAL_X_CARRIAGE_MODE DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default settings in "Auto-park Mode"
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_PARK_ZLIFT   0.2      // the distance to raise Z axis when parking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_UNPARK_ZLIFT 1        // the distance to raise Z axis when unparking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default x offset in duplication mode (typically set to half print bed width)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUPLICATION_X_OFFSET 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif //DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//homing hits the endstop, then retracts by this distance, before it tries to slowly bump again:
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_BUMP_MM 2
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_BUMP_DIVISOR {2, 2, 4}  // Re-Bump Speed Divisor (Divides the Homing Feedrate)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define QUICK_HOME  //if this is defined, if both x and y are to be homed, a diagonal move will be performed initially.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When G28 is called, this option will make Y home before X
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOME_Y_BEFORE_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define AXIS_RELATIVE_MODES {false, false, false, false}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Allow duplication mode with a basic dual-nozzle extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_NOZZLE_DUPLICATION_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// By default pololu step drivers require an active high signal. However, some high power drivers require an active low signal as step.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default stepper release if idle. Set to 0 to deactivate.
 | 
				
			||||
// Steppers will shut down DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME seconds after the last move when DISABLE_INACTIVE_? is true.
 | 
				
			||||
// Time can be set by M18 and M84.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME 120
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_X true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Y true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Z true  // set to false if the nozzle will fall down on your printed part when print has finished.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_E true
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINIMUMFEEDRATE       0.0     // minimum feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINTRAVELFEEDRATE     0.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ULTIPANEL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_FEEDRATE {50*60, 50*60, 4*60, 60} // Feedrates for manual moves along X, Y, Z, E from panel
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ULTIPANEL_FEEDMULTIPLY  // Comment to disable setting feedrate multiplier via encoder
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// minimum time in microseconds that a movement needs to take if the buffer is emptied.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINSEGMENTTIME        20000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If defined the movements slow down when the look ahead buffer is only half full
 | 
				
			||||
#define SLOWDOWN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Frequency limit
 | 
				
			||||
// See nophead's blog for more info
 | 
				
			||||
// Not working O
 | 
				
			||||
//#define XY_FREQUENCY_LIMIT  15
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Minimum planner junction speed. Sets the default minimum speed the planner plans for at the end
 | 
				
			||||
// of the buffer and all stops. This should not be much greater than zero and should only be changed
 | 
				
			||||
// if unwanted behavior is observed on a user's machine when running at very slow speeds.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_PLANNER_SPEED 0.05// (mm/sec)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Microstep setting (Only functional when stepper driver microstep pins are connected to MCU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MICROSTEP_MODES {16,16,16,16,16} // [1,2,4,8,16]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current setting (Only functional when motor driver current ref pins are connected to a digital trimpot on supported boards)
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_MOTOR_CURRENT {135,135,135,135,135} // Values 0-255 (RAMBO 135 = ~0.75A, 185 = ~1A)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current controlled via PWM (Overridable on supported boards with PWM-driven motor driver current)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PWM_MOTOR_CURRENT {1300, 1300, 1250} // Values in milliamps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// uncomment to enable an I2C based DIGIPOT like on the Azteeg X3 Pro
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DIGIPOT_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of channels available for I2C digipot, For Azteeg X3 Pro we have 8
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS 8
 | 
				
			||||
// actual motor currents in Amps, need as many here as DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_MOTOR_CURRENTS {1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Additional Features===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_RATE_MULTIPLIER         // If defined, certain menu edit operations automatically multiply the steps when the encoder is moved quickly
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_10X_STEPS_PER_SEC 75    // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x10 to quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_100X_STEPS_PER_SEC 160  // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x100 to really quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CHDK 4        //Pin for triggering CHDK to take a picture see how to use it here http://captain-slow.dk/2014/03/09/3d-printing-timelapses/
 | 
				
			||||
#define CHDK_DELAY 50 //How long in ms the pin should stay HIGH before going LOW again
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Include a page of printer information in the LCD Main Menu
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_INFO_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// On the Info Screen, display XY with one decimal place when possible
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_DECIMAL_SMALL_XY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The timeout (in ms) to return to the status screen from sub-menus
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_TIMEOUT_TO_STATUS 15000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Some RAMPS and other boards don't detect when an SD card is inserted. You can work
 | 
				
			||||
  // around this by connecting a push button or single throw switch to the pin defined
 | 
				
			||||
  // as SD_DETECT_PIN in your board's pins definitions.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This setting should be disabled unless you are using a push button, pulling the pin to ground.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: This is always disabled for ULTIPANEL (except ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_DETECT_INVERTED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_STEPPERRELEASE true  //if sd support and the file is finished: disable steppers?
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_RELEASECOMMAND "M84 X Y Z E" // You might want to keep the z enabled so your bed stays in place.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SDCARD_RATHERRECENTFIRST  //reverse file order of sd card menu display. Its sorted practically after the file system block order.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if a file is deleted, it frees a block. hence, the order is not purely chronological. To still have auto0.g accessible, there is again the option to do that.
 | 
				
			||||
  // using:
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ADDAUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Sort SD file listings in alphabetical order.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * With this option enabled, items on SD cards will be sorted
 | 
				
			||||
   * by name for easier navigation.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * By default...
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Use the slowest -but safest- method for sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Folders are sorted to the top.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - The sort key is statically allocated.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - No added G-code (M34) support.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - 40 item sorting limit. (Items after the first 40 are unsorted.)
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * SD sorting uses static allocation (as set by SDSORT_LIMIT), allowing the
 | 
				
			||||
   * compiler to calculate the worst-case usage and throw an error if the SRAM
 | 
				
			||||
   * limit is exceeded.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_RAM provides faster sorting via a static directory buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_STACK does the same, but uses a local stack-based buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES will retain the sorted file listing in RAM. (Expensive!)
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM only uses RAM when the SD menu is visible. (Use with caution!)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // SD Card Sorting options
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_LIMIT       40     // Maximum number of sorted items (10-256).
 | 
				
			||||
    #define FOLDER_SORTING     -1     // -1=above  0=none  1=below
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_GCODE       false  // Allow turning sorting on/off with LCD and M34 g-code.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_RAM    false  // Pre-allocate a static array for faster pre-sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_STACK  false  // Prefer the stack for pre-sorting to give back some SRAM. (Negated by next 2 options.)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES false  // Keep sorted items in RAM longer for speedy performance. Most expensive option.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM false  // Use dynamic allocation (within SD menus). Least expensive option. Set SDSORT_LIMIT before use!
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Show a progress bar on HD44780 LCDs for SD printing
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(LCD_PROGRESS_BAR)
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the bar
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_BAR_TIME 2000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the status message
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_MSG_TIME 3000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to retain the status message (0=forever)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_MSG_EXPIRE   0
 | 
				
			||||
    // Enable this to show messages for MSG_TIME then hide them
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define PROGRESS_MSG_ONCE
 | 
				
			||||
    // Add a menu item to test the progress bar:
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This allows hosts to request long names for files and folders with M33
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LONG_FILENAME_HOST_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This option allows you to abort SD printing when any endstop is triggered.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This feature must be enabled with "M540 S1" or from the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
  // To have any effect, endstops must be enabled during SD printing.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ABORT_ON_ENDSTOP_HIT_FEATURE_ENABLED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Additional options for Graphical Displays
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use the optimizations here to improve printing performance,
 | 
				
			||||
 * which can be adversely affected by graphical display drawing,
 | 
				
			||||
 * especially when doing several short moves, and when printing
 | 
				
			||||
 * on DELTA and SCARA machines.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these options may result in the display lagging behind
 | 
				
			||||
 * controller events, as there is a trade-off between reliable
 | 
				
			||||
 * printing performance versus fast display updates.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DOGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on the Info Screen
 | 
				
			||||
  #define XYZ_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on Menu Screens
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MENU_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A bigger font is available for edit items. Costs 3120 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_BIG_EDIT_FONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A smaller font may be used on the Info Screen. Costs 2300 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_SMALL_INFOFONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option and reduce the value to optimize screen updates.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The normal delay is 10µs. Use the lowest value that still gives a reliable display.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DOGM_SPI_DELAY_US 5
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // DOGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section safety
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The hardware watchdog should reset the microcontroller disabling all outputs,
 | 
				
			||||
// in case the firmware gets stuck and doesn't do temperature regulation.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_WATCHDOG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(USE_WATCHDOG)
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you have a watchdog reboot in an ArduinoMega2560 then the device will hang forever, as a watchdog reset will leave the watchdog on.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The "WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL" goes around this by not using the hardware reset.
 | 
				
			||||
  //  However, THIS FEATURE IS UNSAFE!, as it will only work if interrupts are disabled. And the code could hang in an interrupt routine with interrupts disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Babystepping enables the user to control the axis in tiny amounts, independently from the normal printing process
 | 
				
			||||
// it can e.g. be used to change z-positions in the print startup phase in real-time
 | 
				
			||||
// does not respect endstops!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(BABYSTEPPING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_XY  //not only z, but also XY in the menu. more clutter, more functions
 | 
				
			||||
                       //not implemented for deltabots!
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_INVERT_Z false  //true for inverse movements in Z
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_MULTIPLICATOR 1 //faster movements
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// extruder advance constant (s2/mm3)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// advance (steps) = STEPS_PER_CUBIC_MM_E * EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K * cubic mm per second ^ 2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Hooke's law says:    force = k * distance
 | 
				
			||||
// Bernoulli's principle says:  v ^ 2 / 2 + g . h + pressure / density = constant
 | 
				
			||||
// so: v ^ 2 is proportional to number of steps we advance the extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K .0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define D_FILAMENT 2.85
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Implementation of linear pressure control
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Assumption: advance = k * (delta velocity)
 | 
				
			||||
 * K=0 means advance disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 * See Marlin documentation for calibration instructions.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LIN_ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(LIN_ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_K 75
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Some Slicers produce Gcode with randomly jumping extrusion widths occasionally.
 | 
				
			||||
   * For example within a 0.4mm perimeter it may produce a single segment of 0.05mm width.
 | 
				
			||||
   * While this is harmless for normal printing (the fluid nature of the filament will
 | 
				
			||||
   * close this very, very tiny gap), it throws off the LIN_ADVANCE pressure adaption.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * For this case LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO can be used to set the extrusion:distance ratio
 | 
				
			||||
   * to a fixed value. Note that using a fixed ratio will lead to wrong nozzle pressures
 | 
				
			||||
   * if the slicer is using variable widths or layer heights within one print!
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * This option sets the default E:D ratio at startup. Use `M905` to override this value.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example: `M905 W0.4 H0.2 D1.75`, where:
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - W is the extrusion width in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - H is the layer height in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - D is the filament diameter in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Set to 0 to auto-detect the ratio based on given Gcode G1 print moves.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Slic3r (including Prusa Slic3r) produces Gcode compatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Cura (as of this writing) may produce Gcode incompatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO 0 // The calculated ratio (or 0) according to the formula W * H / ((D / 2) ^ 2 * PI)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Example: 0.4 * 0.2 / ((1.75 / 2) ^ 2 * PI) = 0.033260135
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default mesh area is an area with an inset margin on the print area.
 | 
				
			||||
// Below are the macros that are used to define the borders for the mesh area,
 | 
				
			||||
// made available here for specialized needs, ie dual extruder setup.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Arc interpretation settings:
 | 
				
			||||
#define ARC_SUPPORT  // Disabling this saves ~2738 bytes
 | 
				
			||||
#define MM_PER_ARC_SEGMENT 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define N_ARC_CORRECTION 25
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for G5 with XYZE destination and IJPQ offsets. Requires ~2666 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BEZIER_CURVE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// G38.2 and G38.3 Probe Target
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G38_PROBE_TARGET
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(G38_PROBE_TARGET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define G38_MINIMUM_MOVE 0.0275 // minimum distance in mm that will produce a move (determined using the print statement in check_move)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Moves (or segments) with fewer steps than this will be joined with the next move
 | 
				
			||||
#define MIN_STEPS_PER_SEGMENT 6
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimum pulse width (in µs) for stepping a stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set this if you find stepping unreliable, or if using a very fast CPU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_STEPPER_PULSE 0 // (µs) The smallest stepper pulse allowed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Control heater 0 and heater 1 in parallel.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HEATERS_PARALLEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//================================= Buffers =================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section hidden
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of linear motions that can be in the plan at any give time.
 | 
				
			||||
// THE BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE NEEDS TO BE A POWER OF 2, i.g. 8,16,32 because shifts and ors are used to do the ring-buffering.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // SD,LCD,Buttons take more memory, block buffer needs to be smaller
 | 
				
			||||
#else
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // maximize block buffer
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section serial
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The ASCII buffer for serial input
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_CMD_SIZE 96
 | 
				
			||||
#define BUFSIZE 4
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Transfer Buffer Size
 | 
				
			||||
// To save 386 bytes of PROGMEM (and TX_BUFFER_SIZE+3 bytes of RAM) set to 0.
 | 
				
			||||
// To buffer a simple "ok" you need 4 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For ADVANCED_OK (M105) you need 32 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For debug-echo: 128 bytes for the optimal speed.
 | 
				
			||||
// Other output doesn't need to be that speedy.
 | 
				
			||||
// :[0, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256]
 | 
				
			||||
#define TX_BUFFER_SIZE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable an emergency-command parser to intercept certain commands as they
 | 
				
			||||
// enter the serial receive buffer, so they cannot be blocked.
 | 
				
			||||
// Currently handles M108, M112, M410
 | 
				
			||||
// Does not work on boards using AT90USB (USBCON) processors!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EMERGENCY_PARSER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bad Serial-connections can miss a received command by sending an 'ok'
 | 
				
			||||
// Therefore some clients abort after 30 seconds in a timeout.
 | 
				
			||||
// Some other clients start sending commands while receiving a 'wait'.
 | 
				
			||||
// This "wait" is only sent when the buffer is empty. 1 second is a good value here.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_TIMEOUTS 1000 // Milliseconds
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Some clients will have this feature soon. This could make the NO_TIMEOUTS unnecessary.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCED_OK
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section fwretract
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Firmware based and LCD controlled retract
 | 
				
			||||
// M207 and M208 can be used to define parameters for the retraction.
 | 
				
			||||
// The retraction can be called by the slicer using G10 and G11
 | 
				
			||||
// until then, intended retractions can be detected by moves that only extrude and the direction.
 | 
				
			||||
// the moves are than replaced by the firmware controlled ones.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FWRETRACT  //ONLY PARTIALLY TESTED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FWRETRACT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_RETRACT 0.1                //minimum extruded mm to accept a automatic gcode retraction attempt
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH 3               //default retract length (positive mm)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH_SWAP 13         //default swap retract length (positive mm), for extruder change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_FEEDRATE 45            //default feedrate for retracting (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_ZLIFT 0                //default retract Z-lift
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH 0       //default additional recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH_SWAP 0  //default additional swap recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering from extruder change)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_FEEDRATE 8     //default feedrate for recovering from retraction (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Change
 | 
				
			||||
 * Experimental filament change support.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Adds the GCode M600 for initiating filament change.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Requires an LCD display.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is required for the default FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_X_POS 3             // X position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Y_POS 3             // Y position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_ADD 10            // Z addition of hotend (lift)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_XY_FEEDRATE 100     // X and Y axes feedrate in mm/s (also used for delta printers Z axis)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_FEEDRATE 5        // Z axis feedrate in mm/s (not used for delta printers)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_FEEDRATE 60 // Initial retract feedrate in mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_LENGTH 2    // Initial retract in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // It is a short retract used immediately after print interrupt before move to filament exchange position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_FEEDRATE 10  // Unload filament feedrate in mm/s - filament unloading can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_LENGTH 100   // Unload filament length from hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to unload filament from whole bowden tube,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // shorter length for printers without bowden to unload filament from extruder only,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable unloading for manual unloading
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_FEEDRATE 6     // Load filament feedrate in mm/s - filament loading into the bowden tube can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_LENGTH 0       // Load filament length over hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to fast load filament into whole bowden tube over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Short or zero length for printers without bowden where loading is not used
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_FEEDRATE 3  // Extrude filament feedrate in mm/s - must be slower than load feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_LENGTH 50   // Extrude filament length in mm after filament is loaded over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable for manual extrusion
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Filament can be extruded repeatedly from the filament exchange menu to fill the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // or until outcoming filament color is not clear for filament color change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NOZZLE_TIMEOUT 45L  // Turn off nozzle if user doesn't change filament within this time limit in seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NUMBER_OF_ALERT_BEEPS  5L  // Number of alert beeps before printer goes quiet
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NO_STEPPER_TIMEOUT         // Enable to have stepper motors hold position during filament change
 | 
				
			||||
                                                     // even if it takes longer than DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section tmc
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have TMC26X motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You will need to import the TMC26XStepper library into the Arduino IDE for this
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/trinamic/TMC26XStepper.git)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMCDRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMCDRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000 // in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_SENSE_RESISTOR    91 // in mOhms
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this for SilentStepStick Trinamic TMC2130 SPI-configurable stepper drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You'll also need the TMC2130Stepper Arduino library
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper).
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * To use TMC2130 stepper drivers in SPI mode connect your SPI2130 pins to
 | 
				
			||||
 * the hardware SPI interface on your board and define the required CS pins
 | 
				
			||||
 * in your `pins_MYBOARD.h` file. (e.g., RAMPS 1.4 uses AUX3 pins `X_CS_PIN 53`, `Y_CS_PIN 49`, etc.).
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define STEALTHCHOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Let Marlin automatically control stepper current.
 | 
				
			||||
   * This is still an experimental feature.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Increase current every 5s by CURRENT_STEP until stepper temperature prewarn gets triggered,
 | 
				
			||||
   * then decrease current by CURRENT_STEP until temperature prewarn is cleared.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Adjusting starts from X/Y/Z/E_MAX_CURRENT but will not increase over AUTO_ADJUST_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define AUTOMATIC_CURRENT_CONTROL
 | 
				
			||||
  #define CURRENT_STEP          50  // [mA]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTO_ADJUST_MAX     1300  // [mA], 1300mA_rms = 1840mA_peak
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // CHOOSE YOUR MOTORS HERE, THIS IS MANDATORY
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Stepper driver settings
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define R_SENSE           0.11  // R_sense resistor for SilentStepStick2130
 | 
				
			||||
  #define HOLD_MULTIPLIER    0.5  // Scales down the holding current from run current
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INTERPOLATE          1  // Interpolate X/Y/Z_MICROSTEPS to 256
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000  // rms current in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16  // FULLSTEP..256
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_CHIP_SELECT       40  // Pin
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_CHIP_SELECT       42
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_CHIP_SELECT       65
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * You can set your own advanced settings by filling in predefined functions.
 | 
				
			||||
   * A list of available functions can be found on the library github page
 | 
				
			||||
   * https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example:
 | 
				
			||||
   * #define TMC2130_ADV() { \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.diag0_temp_prewarn(1); \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.interpolate(0); \
 | 
				
			||||
   * }
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  TMC2130_ADV() {  }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have L6470 motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You need to import the L6470 library into the Arduino IDE for this.
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/ameyer/Arduino-L6470)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section l6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_L6470DRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_L6470DRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS      16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_K_VAL           50 // 0 - 255, Higher values, are higher power. Be careful not to go too high
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_OVERCURRENT   2000 // maxc current in mA. If the current goes over this value, the driver will switch off
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_STALLCURRENT  1500 // current in mA where the driver will detect a stall
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * TWI/I2C BUS
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is an EXPERIMENTAL feature so it shall not be used on production
 | 
				
			||||
 * machines. Enabling this will allow you to send and receive I2C data from slave
 | 
				
			||||
 * devices on the bus.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #1
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; This macro send the string "Marlin" to the slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; It uses multiple M260 commands with one B<base 10> arg
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 A99  ; Target slave address
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B77  ; M
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B97  ; a
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B114 ; r
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B108 ; l
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B105 ; i
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B110 ; n
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 S1   ; Send the current buffer
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #2
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Request 6 bytes from slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * M261 A99 B5
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #3
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example serial output of a M261 request
 | 
				
			||||
 * echo:i2c-reply: from:99 bytes:5 data:hello
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section i2cbus
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXPERIMENTAL_I2CBUS
 | 
				
			||||
#define I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS  0 // Set a value from 8 to 127 to act as a slave
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Add M43, M44 and M45 commands for pins info and testing
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PINS_DEBUGGING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Auto-report temperatures with M155 S<seconds>
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_REPORT_TEMPERATURES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Include capabilities in M115 output
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTENDED_CAPABILITIES_REPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Double-click the Encoder button on the Status Screen for Z Babystepping.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DOUBLECLICK_FOR_Z_BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#define DOUBLECLICK_MAX_INTERVAL 1250   // Maximum interval between clicks, in milliseconds.
 | 
				
			||||
                                        // Note: You may need to add extra time to mitigate controller latency.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Volumetric extrusion default state
 | 
				
			||||
 * Activate to make volumetric extrusion the default method,
 | 
				
			||||
 * with DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA as the default diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * M200 D0 to disable, M200 Dn to set a new diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VOLUMETRIC_DEFAULT_ON
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this option for a leaner build of Marlin that removes all
 | 
				
			||||
 * workspace offsets, simplifying coordinate transformations, leveling, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - M206 and M428 are disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - G92 will revert to its behavior from Marlin 1.0.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_WORKSPACE_OFFSETS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
@ -1,1505 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings such as:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of electronics
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Type of temperature sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Printer geometry
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Endstop configuration
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LCD controller
 | 
				
			||||
 * - Extra features
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings can be found in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Getting Started =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Here are some standard links for getting your machine calibrated:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Calibration
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://youtu.be/wAL9d7FgInk
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://calculator.josefprusa.cz
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://reprap.org/wiki/Triffid_Hunter%27s_Calibration_Guide
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:5573
 | 
				
			||||
 * https://sites.google.com/site/repraplogphase/calibration-of-your-reprap
 | 
				
			||||
 * http://www.thingiverse.com/thing:298812
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= DELTA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Delta printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/delta directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= SCARA Printer ===============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// For a Scara printer replace the configuration files with the files in the
 | 
				
			||||
// example_configurations/SCARA directory.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section info
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// User-specified version info of this build to display in [Pronterface, etc] terminal window during
 | 
				
			||||
// startup. Implementation of an idea by Prof Braino to inform user that any changes made to this
 | 
				
			||||
// build by the user have been successfully uploaded into firmware.
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_CONFIG_H_AUTHOR "(none, default config)" // Who made the changes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SHOW_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE1 SHORT_BUILD_VERSION // will be shown during bootup in line 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define STRING_SPLASH_LINE2 WEBSITE_URL         // will be shown during bootup in line 2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// *** VENDORS PLEASE READ *****************************************************
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin now allow you to have a vendor boot image to be displayed on machine
 | 
				
			||||
// start. When SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN is defined Marlin will first show your
 | 
				
			||||
// custom boot image and then the default Marlin boot image is shown.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// We suggest for you to take advantage of this new feature and keep the Marlin
 | 
				
			||||
// boot image unmodified. For an example have a look at the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
// example configuration folder.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_CUSTOM_BOOTSCREEN
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select which serial port on the board will be used for communication with the host.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This allows the connection of wireless adapters (for instance) to non-default port pins.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Serial port 0 is always used by the Arduino bootloader regardless of this setting.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERIAL_PORT 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * This setting determines the communication speed of the printer.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 250000 works in most cases, but you might try a lower speed if
 | 
				
			||||
 * you commonly experience drop-outs during host printing.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :[2400, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200, 250000]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define BAUDRATE 250000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable the Bluetooth serial interface on AT90USB devices
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLUETOOTH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The following define selects which electronics board you have.
 | 
				
			||||
// Please choose the name from boards.h that matches your setup
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef MOTHERBOARD
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MOTHERBOARD BOARD_RAMPS_14_EFB
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Optional custom name for your RepStrap or other custom machine
 | 
				
			||||
// Displayed in the LCD "Ready" message
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CUSTOM_MACHINE_NAME "3D Printer"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define this to set a unique identifier for this printer, (Used by some programs to differentiate between machines)
 | 
				
			||||
// You can use an online service to generate a random UUID. (eg http://www.uuidgenerator.net/version4)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MACHINE_UUID "00000000-0000-0000-0000-000000000000"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the number of extruders
 | 
				
			||||
// :[1, 2, 3, 4]
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDERS 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if your E steppers or extruder gear ratios are not identical
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISTINCT_E_FACTORS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Cyclops or any "multi-extruder" that shares a single nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SINGLENOZZLE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual extruder that uses a single stepper motor
 | 
				
			||||
// Don't forget to set SSDE_SERVO_ANGLES and HOTEND_OFFSET_X/Y/Z
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SWITCHING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SWITCHING_EXTRUDER_SERVO_ANGLES { 0, 90 } // Angles for E0, E1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Z {0.0, 0.0}
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Mixing Extruder"
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Adds a new code, M165, to set the current mix factors.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Extends the stepping routines to move multiple steppers in proportion to the mix.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Optional support for Repetier Host M163, M164, and virtual extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - This implementation supports only a single extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   - Enable DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1 for Pia Taubert's reference implementation
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MIXING_EXTRUDER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MIXING_EXTRUDER)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_STEPPERS 2        // Number of steppers in your mixing extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIXING_VIRTUAL_TOOLS 16  // Use the Virtual Tool method with M163 and M164
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DIRECT_MIXING_IN_G1    // Allow ABCDHI mix factors in G1 movement commands
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Offset of the extruders (uncomment if using more than one and relying on firmware to position when changing).
 | 
				
			||||
// The offset has to be X=0, Y=0 for the extruder 0 hotend (default extruder).
 | 
				
			||||
// For the other hotends it is their distance from the extruder 0 hotend.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_X {0.0, 20.00} // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the X axis
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOTEND_OFFSET_Y {0.0, 5.00}  // (in mm) for each extruder, offset of the hotend on the Y axis
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select your power supply here. Use 0 if you haven't connected the PS_ON_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * 0 = No Power Switch
 | 
				
			||||
 * 1 = ATX
 | 
				
			||||
 * 2 = X-Box 360 203Watts (the blue wire connected to PS_ON and the red wire to VCC)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ 0:'No power switch', 1:'ATX', 2:'X-Box 360' }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define POWER_SUPPLY 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if POWER_SUPPLY > 0
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option to leave the PSU off at startup.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Power to steppers and heaters will need to be turned on with M80.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PS_DEFAULT_OFF
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Thermal Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * --NORMAL IS 4.7kohm PULLUP!-- 1kohm pullup can be used on hotend sensor, using correct resistor and table
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Temperature sensors available:
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -3 : thermocouple with MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -2 : thermocouple with MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    -1 : thermocouple with AD595
 | 
				
			||||
 *     0 : not used
 | 
				
			||||
 *     1 : 100k thermistor - best choice for EPCOS 100k (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     2 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     3 : Mendel-parts thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     4 : 10k thermistor !! do not use it for a hotend. It gives bad resolution at high temp. !!
 | 
				
			||||
 *     5 : 100K thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     6 : 100k EPCOS - Not as accurate as table 1 (created using a fluke thermocouple) (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     7 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAG-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    71 : 100k Honeywell thermistor 135-104LAF-J01 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     8 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *     9 : 100k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    10 : 100k RS thermistor 198-961 (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    11 : 100k beta 3950 1% thermistor (4.7k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    12 : 100k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (4.7k pullup) (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    13 : 100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend "Simple ONE " & "Hotend "All In ONE"
 | 
				
			||||
 *    20 : the PT100 circuit found in the Ultimainboard V2.x
 | 
				
			||||
 *    60 : 100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950
 | 
				
			||||
 *    66 : 4.7M High Temperature thermistor from Dyze Design
 | 
				
			||||
 *    70 : the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2
 | 
				
			||||
 *    75 : 100k Generic Silicon Heat Pad with NTC 100K MGB18-104F39050L32 thermistor
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *       1k ohm pullup tables - This is atypical, and requires changing out the 4.7k pullup for 1k.
 | 
				
			||||
 *                              (but gives greater accuracy and more stable PID)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    51 : 100k thermistor - EPCOS (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    52 : 200k thermistor - ATC Semitec 204GT-2 (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *    55 : 100k thermistor - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head) (1k pullup)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1047 : Pt1000 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *  1010 : Pt1000 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   147 : Pt100 with 4k7 pullup
 | 
				
			||||
 *   110 : Pt100 with 1k pullup (non standard)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *         Use these for Testing or Development purposes. NEVER for production machine.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   998 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 25°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   999 : Dummy Table that ALWAYS reads 100°C or the temperature defined below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * :{ '0': "Not used", '1':"100k / 4.7k - EPCOS", '2':"200k / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '3':"Mendel-parts / 4.7k", '4':"10k !! do not use for a hotend. Bad resolution at high temp. !!", '5':"100K / 4.7k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '6':"100k / 4.7k EPCOS - Not as accurate as Table 1", '7':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAG-J01", '8':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT", '9':"100k / 4.7k GE Sensing AL03006-58.2K-97-G1", '10':"100k / 4.7k RS 198-961", '11':"100k / 4.7k beta 3950 1%", '12':"100k / 4.7k 0603 SMD Vishay NTCS0603E3104FXT (calibrated for Makibox hot bed)", '13':"100k Hisens 3950  1% up to 300°C for hotend 'Simple ONE ' & hotend 'All In ONE'", '20':"PT100 (Ultimainboard V2.x)", '51':"100k / 1k - EPCOS", '52':"200k / 1k - ATC Semitec 204GT-2", '55':"100k / 1k - ATC Semitec 104GT-2 (Used in ParCan & J-Head)", '60':"100k Maker's Tool Works Kapton Bed Thermistor beta=3950", '66':"Dyze Design 4.7M High Temperature thermistor", '70':"the 100K thermistor found in the bq Hephestos 2", '71':"100k / 4.7k Honeywell 135-104LAF-J01", '147':"Pt100 / 4.7k", '1047':"Pt1000 / 4.7k", '110':"Pt100 / 1k (non-standard)", '1010':"Pt1000 / 1k (non standard)", '-3':"Thermocouple + MAX31855 (only for sensor 0)", '-2':"Thermocouple + MAX6675 (only for sensor 0)", '-1':"Thermocouple + AD595",'998':"Dummy 1", '999':"Dummy 2" }
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_0 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_1 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_2 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_3 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_BED 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dummy thermistor constant temperature readings, for use with 998 and 999
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_998_VALUE 25
 | 
				
			||||
#define DUMMY_THERMISTOR_999_VALUE 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use temp sensor 1 as a redundant sensor with sensor 0. If the readings
 | 
				
			||||
// from the two sensors differ too much the print will be aborted.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_SENSOR_1_AS_REDUNDANT
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_REDUNDANT_TEMP_SENSOR_DIFF 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder temperature must be close to target for this long before M109 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bed temperature must be close to target for this long before M190 returns success
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_RESIDENCY_TIME 10  // (seconds)
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_HYSTERESIS 3       // (degC) range of +/- temperatures considered "close" to the target one
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_BED_WINDOW     1       // (degC) Window around target to start the residency timer x degC early.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimal temperature defines the temperature below which the heater will not be enabled It is used
 | 
				
			||||
// to check that the wiring to the thermistor is not broken.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise this would lead to the heater being powered on all the time.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MINTEMP 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When temperature exceeds max temp, your heater will be switched off.
 | 
				
			||||
// This feature exists to protect your hotend from overheating accidentally, but *NOT* from thermistor short/failure!
 | 
				
			||||
// You should use MINTEMP for thermistor short/failure protection.
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_0_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_1_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_2_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define HEATER_3_MAXTEMP 275
 | 
				
			||||
#define BED_MAXTEMP 150
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID Settings ================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// PID Tuning Guide here: http://reprap.org/wiki/PID_Tuning
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Comment the following line to disable PID and enable bang-bang.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#define BANG_MAX 255 // limits current to nozzle while in bang-bang mode; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#define PID_MAX BANG_MAX // limits current to nozzle while PID is active (see PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE below); 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_AUTOTUNE_MENU // Add PID Autotune to the LCD "Temperature" menu to run M303 and apply the result.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_OPENLOOP 1 // Puts PID in open loop. M104/M140 sets the output power from 0 to PID_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SLOW_PWM_HEATERS // PWM with very low frequency (roughly 0.125Hz=8s) and minimum state time of approximately 1s useful for heaters driven by a relay
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_PARAMS_PER_HOTEND // Uses separate PID parameters for each extruder (useful for mismatched extruders)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Set/get with gcode: M301 E[extruder number, 0-2]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE 10 // If the temperature difference between the target temperature and the actual temperature
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // is more than PID_FUNCTIONAL_RANGE then the PID will be shut off and the heater will be set to min/max.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define K1 0.95 //smoothing factor within the PID
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you are using a pre-configured hotend then you can use one of the value sets by uncommenting it
 | 
				
			||||
  // Ultimaker
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kp 22.2
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Ki 1.08
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_Kd 114
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // MakerGear
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 7.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 0.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Mendel Parts V9 on 12V
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kp 63.0
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Ki 2.25
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_Kd 440
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= PID > Bed Temperature Control ===============
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// Select PID or bang-bang with PIDTEMPBED. If bang-bang, BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING will enable hysteresis
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this to enable PID on the bed. It uses the same frequency PWM as the extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your PID_dT is the default, and correct for your hardware/configuration, that means 7.689Hz,
 | 
				
			||||
// which is fine for driving a square wave into a resistive load and does not significantly impact you FET heating.
 | 
				
			||||
// This also works fine on a Fotek SSR-10DA Solid State Relay into a 250W heater.
 | 
				
			||||
// If your configuration is significantly different than this and you don't understand the issues involved, you probably
 | 
				
			||||
// shouldn't use bed PID until someone else verifies your hardware works.
 | 
				
			||||
// If this is enabled, find your own PID constants below.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This sets the max power delivered to the bed, and replaces the HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER option.
 | 
				
			||||
// all forms of bed control obey this (PID, bang-bang, bang-bang with hysteresis)
 | 
				
			||||
// setting this to anything other than 255 enables a form of PWM to the bed just like HEATER_BED_DUTY_CYCLE_DIVIDER did,
 | 
				
			||||
// so you shouldn't use it unless you are OK with PWM on your bed.  (see the comment on enabling PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_BED_POWER 255 // limits duty cycle to bed; 255=full current
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_BED_DEBUG // Sends debug data to the serial port.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from FOPDT model - kp=.39 Tp=405 Tdead=66, Tc set to 79.2, aggressive factor of .15 (vs .1, 1, 10)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKp 10.00
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKi .023
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  DEFAULT_bedKd 305.4
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //120V 250W silicone heater into 4mm borosilicate (MendelMax 1.5+)
 | 
				
			||||
  //from pidautotune
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKp 97.1
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKi 1.41
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define  DEFAULT_bedKd 1675.16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // FIND YOUR OWN: "M303 E-1 C8 S90" to run autotune on the bed at 90 degreesC for 8 cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // PIDTEMPBED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents extrusion if the temperature is below EXTRUDE_MINTEMP.
 | 
				
			||||
// It also enables the M302 command to set the minimum extrusion temperature
 | 
				
			||||
// or to allow moving the extruder regardless of the hotend temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// *** IT IS HIGHLY RECOMMENDED TO LEAVE THIS OPTION ENABLED! ***
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_COLD_EXTRUSION
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MINTEMP 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This option prevents a single extrusion longer than EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH.
 | 
				
			||||
// Note that for Bowden Extruders a too-small value here may prevent loading.
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREVENT_LENGTHY_EXTRUDE
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDE_MAXLENGTH 200
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//======================== Thermal Runaway Protection =======================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get "Thermal Runaway" or "Heating failed" errors the
 | 
				
			||||
 * details can be tuned in Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS // Enable thermal protection for all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED     // Enable thermal protection for the heated bed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Mechanical Settings =========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment one of these options to enable CoreXY, CoreXZ, or CoreYZ kinematics
 | 
				
			||||
// either in the usual order or reversed
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXY
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREXZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYZ
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREYX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZX
 | 
				
			||||
//#define COREZY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option for Toshiba steppers
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CONFIG_STEPPERS_TOSHIBA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Endstop Settings ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Specify here all the endstop connectors that are connected to any endstop or probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// Almost all printers will be using one per axis. Probes will use one or more of the
 | 
				
			||||
// extra connectors. Leave undefined any used for non-endstop and non-probe purposes.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_XMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_YMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_ZMIN_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_XMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_YMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
//#define USE_ZMAX_PLUG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// coarse Endstop Settings
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENDSTOPPULLUPS // Comment this out (using // at the start of the line) to disable the endstop pullup resistors
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(ENDSTOPPULLUPS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // fine endstop settings: Individual pullups. will be ignored if ENDSTOPPULLUPS is defined
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMAX
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_XMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_YMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ENDSTOPPULLUP_ZMIN_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Mechanical endstop with COM to ground and NC to Signal uses "false" here (most common setup).
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the probe.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this feature if all enabled endstop pins are interrupt-capable.
 | 
				
			||||
// This will remove the need to poll the interrupt pins, saving many CPU cycles.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOP_INTERRUPTS_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================== Movement Settings ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section motion
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Settings
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * These settings can be reset by M502
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You can set distinct factors for each E stepper, if needed.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If fewer factors are given, the last will apply to the rest.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note that if EEPROM is enabled, saved values will override these.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Axis Steps Per Unit (steps/mm)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M92
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_AXIS_STEPS_PER_UNIT   { 80, 80, 4000, 500 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Feed Rate (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M203
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_FEEDRATE          { 300, 300, 5, 25 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Max Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * (Maximum start speed for accelerated moves)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M201
 | 
				
			||||
 *                                      X, Y, Z, E0 [, E1[, E2[, E3]]]
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MAX_ACCELERATION      { 3000, 3000, 100, 10000 }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Acceleration (change/s) change = mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M204
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 P    Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 R    Retract Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 *   M204 T    Travel Acceleration
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ACCELERATION          3000    // X, Y, Z and E acceleration for printing moves
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_RETRACT_ACCELERATION  3000    // E acceleration for retracts
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_TRAVEL_ACCELERATION   3000    // X, Y, Z acceleration for travel (non printing) moves
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Default Jerk (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Override with M205 X Y Z E
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * "Jerk" specifies the minimum speed change that requires acceleration.
 | 
				
			||||
 * When changing speed and direction, if the difference is less than the
 | 
				
			||||
 * value set here, it may happen instantaneously.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_XJERK                 20.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_YJERK                 20.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_ZJERK                  0.4
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_EJERK                  5.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Z Probe Options =============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section probes
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Probe Type
 | 
				
			||||
// Probes are sensors/switches that are activated / deactivated before/after use.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probes, Servo Probes, Z-Sled Probes, FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
// You must activate one of these to use Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use M851 to set the Z probe vertical offset from the nozzle. Store with M500.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A Fix-Mounted Probe either doesn't deploy or needs manual deployment.
 | 
				
			||||
// For example an inductive probe, or a setup that uses the nozzle to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// An inductive probe must be deactivated to go below
 | 
				
			||||
// its trigger-point if hardware endstops are active.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FIX_MOUNTED_PROBE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The BLTouch probe emulates a servo probe.
 | 
				
			||||
// The default connector is SERVO 0. Set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR below to override.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLTOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Servo Probe, such as an endstop switch on a rotating arm.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_SERVO_ANGLES {70,0} // Z Servo Deploy and Stow angles
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable if you have a Z probe mounted on a sled like those designed by Charles Bell.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_SLED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SLED_DOCKING_OFFSET 5 // The extra distance the X axis must travel to pickup the sled. 0 should be fine but you can push it further if you'd like.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Z Probe to nozzle (X,Y) offset, relative to (0, 0).
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y offsets must be integers.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In the following example the X and Y offsets are both positive:
 | 
				
			||||
// #define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
// #define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    +-- BACK ---+
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//  L |    (+) P  | R <-- probe (20,20)
 | 
				
			||||
//  E |           | I
 | 
				
			||||
//  F | (-) N (+) | G <-- nozzle (10,10)
 | 
				
			||||
//  T |           | H
 | 
				
			||||
//    |    (-)    | T
 | 
				
			||||
//    |           |
 | 
				
			||||
//    O-- FRONT --+
 | 
				
			||||
//  (0,0)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10  // X offset: -left  +right  [of the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 10  // Y offset: -front +behind [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER 0   // Z offset: -below +above  [the nozzle]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// X and Y axis travel speed (mm/m) between probes
 | 
				
			||||
#define XY_PROBE_SPEED 8000
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the first approach when double-probing (with PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH)
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z
 | 
				
			||||
// Speed for the "accurate" probe of each point
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_SPEED_SLOW (Z_PROBE_SPEED_FAST / 2)
 | 
				
			||||
// Use double touch for probing
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PROBE_DOUBLE_TOUCH
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Allen Key Probe is defined in the Delta example configurations.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// *** PLEASE READ ALL INSTRUCTIONS BELOW FOR SAFETY! ***
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To continue using the Z-min-endstop for homing, be sure to disable Z_SAFE_HOMING.
 | 
				
			||||
// Example: To park the head outside the bed area when homing with G28.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a separate Z probe, your board must define a Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For a servo-based Z probe, just set Z_ENDSTOP_SERVO_NR and Z_SERVO_ANGLES above.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - RAMPS 1.3/1.4 boards may be able to use the 5V, GND, and Aux4->D32 pin.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Use 5V for powered (usu. inductive) sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Otherwise connect:
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-closed switches to GND and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//   - normally-open switches to 5V and D32.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Normally-closed switches are advised and are the default.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN sets the Arduino pin to use. (See your board's pins file.)
 | 
				
			||||
// Since the RAMPS Aux4->D32 pin maps directly to the Arduino D32 pin, D32 is the
 | 
				
			||||
// default pin for all RAMPS-based boards. Most boards use the X_MAX_PIN by default.
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a different pin you can override it here.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING:
 | 
				
			||||
// Setting the wrong pin may have unexpected and potentially disastrous consequences.
 | 
				
			||||
// Use with caution and do your homework.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN X_MAX_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP to use _both_ a Z Probe and a Z-min-endstop on the same machine.
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option the Z_MIN_PROBE_PIN will only be used for probing, never for homing.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_ENDSTOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN to use the Z_MIN_PIN for your Z_MIN_PROBE.
 | 
				
			||||
// The Z_MIN_PIN will then be used for both Z-homing and probing.
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_PROBE_USES_Z_MIN_ENDSTOP_PIN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// To use a probe you must enable one of the two options above!
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable Z Probe Repeatability test to see how accurate your probe is
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_MIN_PROBE_REPEATABILITY_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Z probes require clearance when deploying, stowing, and moving between
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe points to avoid hitting the bed and other hardware.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Servo-mounted probes require extra space for the arm to rotate.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Inductive probes need space to keep from triggering early.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use these settings to specify the distance (mm) to raise the probe (or
 | 
				
			||||
 * lower the bed). The values set here apply over and above any (negative)
 | 
				
			||||
 * probe Z Offset set with Z_PROBE_OFFSET_FROM_EXTRUDER, M851, or the LCD.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only integer values >= 1 are valid here.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Example: `M851 Z-5` with a CLEARANCE of 4  =>  9mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     But: `M851 Z+1` with a CLEARANCE of 2  =>  2mm from bed to nozzle.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_DEPLOY_PROBE   10 // Z Clearance for Deploy/Stow
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_CLEARANCE_BETWEEN_PROBES  5 // Z Clearance between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// For M851 give a range for adjusting the Z probe offset
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MIN -20
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_PROBE_OFFSET_RANGE_MAX 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For Inverting Stepper Enable Pins (Active Low) use 0, Non Inverting (Active High) use 1
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 0:'Low', 1:'High' }
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_ENABLE_ON 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define E_ENABLE_ON 0 // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Disables axis stepper immediately when it's not being used.
 | 
				
			||||
// WARNING: When motors turn off there is a chance of losing position accuracy!
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_X false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Y false
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_Z false
 | 
				
			||||
// Warn on display about possibly reduced accuracy
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DISABLE_REDUCED_ACCURACY_WARNING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_E false // For all extruders
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_EXTRUDER true //disable only inactive extruders and keep active extruder enabled
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Invert the stepper direction. Change (or reverse the motor connector) if an axis goes the wrong way.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// For direct drive extruder v9 set to true, for geared extruder set to false.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E0_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E1_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E2_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E3_DIR false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_HOMING_HEIGHT 4  // (in mm) Minimal z height before homing (G28) for Z clearance above the bed, clamps, ...
 | 
				
			||||
                             // Be sure you have this distance over your Z_MAX_POS in case.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Direction of endstops when homing; 1=MAX, -1=MIN
 | 
				
			||||
// :[-1,1]
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_DIR -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Travel limits after homing (units are in mm)
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MIN_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_MAX_POS 200
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move below MIN_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MIN_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
// If enabled, axes won't move above MAX_POS in response to movement commands.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_SOFTWARE_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Runout Sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * A mechanical or opto endstop is used to check for the presence of filament.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * RAMPS-based boards use SERVO3_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * For other boards you may need to define FIL_RUNOUT_PIN.
 | 
				
			||||
 * By default the firmware assumes HIGH = has filament, LOW = ran out
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FIL_RUNOUT_INVERTING false // set to true to invert the logic of the sensor.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENDSTOPPULLUP_FIL_RUNOUT // Uncomment to use internal pullup for filament runout pins if the sensor is defined.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT "M600"
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Bed Leveling ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//==========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
// @section bedlevel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Select one form of Auto Bed Leveling below.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  If you're also using the Probe for Z Homing, it's
 | 
				
			||||
 *  highly recommended to enable Z_SAFE_HOMING also!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - 3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe 3 arbitrary points on the bed (that aren't collinear)
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the XY coordinates of all 3 points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a single tilted plane. Best for a flat bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Probe several points in a grid.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   You specify the rectangle and the density of sample points.
 | 
				
			||||
 *   The result is a mesh, best for large or uneven beds.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * - UBL Unified Bed Leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 *   A comprehensive bed leveling system that combines features and benefits from previous
 | 
				
			||||
 *   bed leveling system.  The UBL Bed Leveling System also includes an integrated and easy to use
 | 
				
			||||
 *   Mesh Generation, Mesh Validation and Mesh Editing system.
 | 
				
			||||
 *     - Currently, the UBL Bed Leveling System is only checked out for Cartesian Printers.  But with
 | 
				
			||||
 *       that said, it was primarily designed to handle poor quality Delta Printers.  If you feel
 | 
				
			||||
 *       adventurous and have a Delta, please post an issue if something doesn't work correctly.
 | 
				
			||||
 *       Initially, you will need to reduce your declared bed size so you have a rectangular area to
 | 
				
			||||
 *       test on.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MESH_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable detailed logging of G28, G29, M48, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Turn on with the command 'M111 S32'.
 | 
				
			||||
 * NOTE: Requires a lot of PROGMEM!
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DEBUG_LEVELING_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Gradually reduce leveling correction until a set height is reached,
 | 
				
			||||
  // at which point movement will be level to the machine's XY plane.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The height can be set with M420 Z<height>
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ENABLE_LEVELING_FADE_HEIGHT
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_LINEAR) || ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the number of grid points per dimension.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X 3
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_Y ABL_GRID_MAX_POINTS_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set the boundaries for probing (where the probe can reach).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LEFT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RIGHT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FRONT_PROBE_BED_POSITION 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BACK_PROBE_BED_POSITION 170
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // The Z probe minimum outer margin (to validate G29 parameters).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_PROBE_EDGE 10
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Probe along the Y axis, advancing X after each column
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PROBE_Y_FIRST
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_BILINEAR)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    // Experimental Subdivision of the grid by Catmull-Rom method.
 | 
				
			||||
    // Synthesizes intermediate points to produce a more detailed mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
    //
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION
 | 
				
			||||
    #if ENABLED(ABL_BILINEAR_SUBDIVISION)
 | 
				
			||||
      // Number of subdivisions between probe points
 | 
				
			||||
      #define BILINEAR_SUBDIVISIONS 3
 | 
				
			||||
    #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_3POINT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // 3 arbitrary points to probe.
 | 
				
			||||
  // A simple cross-product is used to estimate the plane of the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_X 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 180
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_X 15
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_X 170
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ABL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=================================== Mesh ==================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_PROBE_Z_RANGE 4 // Z after Home, bed somewhere below but above 0.0.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_INSET 10          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 3    // Don't use more than 7 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MESH_G28_REST_ORIGIN // After homing all axes ('G28' or 'G28 XYZ') rest at origin [0,0,0]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MANUAL_BED_LEVELING  // Add display menu option for bed leveling.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(MANUAL_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define MBL_Z_STEP 0.025     // Step size while manually probing Z axis.
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif  // MANUAL_BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#elif ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//========================= Unified Bed Leveling ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_INSET 1          // Mesh inset margin on print area
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_X_POINTS 10  // Don't use more than 15 points per axis, implementation limited.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_NUM_Y_POINTS 10
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_X 39       // These set the probe locations for when UBL does a 3-Point leveling
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_1_Y 180      // of the mesh.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_X 39
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_2_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_X 180
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_PROBE_PT_3_Y 20
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif  // BED_LEVELING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Commands to execute at the end of G29 probing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Useful to retract or move the Z probe out of the way.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_PROBE_END_SCRIPT "G1 Z10 F12000\nG1 X15 Y330\nG1 Z0.5\nG1 Z10"
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The center of the bed is at (X=0, Y=0)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BED_CENTER_AT_0_0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Manually set the home position. Leave these undefined for automatic settings.
 | 
				
			||||
// For DELTA this is the top-center of the Cartesian print volume.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_X_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_Y_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MANUAL_Z_HOME_POS 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use "Z Safe Homing" to avoid homing with a Z probe outside the bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this feature enabled:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - Allow Z homing only after X and Y homing AND stepper drivers still enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// - If stepper drivers time out, it will need X and Y homing again before Z homing.
 | 
				
			||||
// - Move the Z probe (or nozzle) to a defined XY point before Z Homing when homing all axes (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
// - Prevent Z homing when the Z probe is outside bed area.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_SAFE_HOMING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_SAFE_HOMING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_X_POINT ((X_MIN_POS + X_MAX_POS) / 2)    // X point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SAFE_HOMING_Y_POINT ((Y_MIN_POS + Y_MAX_POS) / 2)    // Y point for Z homing when homing all axis (G28).
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Homing speeds (mm/m)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_XY (50*60)
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_FEEDRATE_Z  (4*60)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= Additional Features ===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The microcontroller can store settings in the EEPROM, e.g. max velocity...
 | 
				
			||||
// M500 - stores parameters in EEPROM
 | 
				
			||||
// M501 - reads parameters from EEPROM (if you need reset them after you changed them temporarily).
 | 
				
			||||
// M502 - reverts to the default "factory settings".  You still need to store them in EEPROM afterwards if you want to.
 | 
				
			||||
//define this to enable EEPROM support
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EEPROM_SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EEPROM_SETTINGS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // To disable EEPROM Serial responses and decrease program space by ~1700 byte: comment this out:
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EEPROM_CHITCHAT // Please keep turned on if you can.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Host Keepalive
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will send a busy status message to the host
 | 
				
			||||
// every couple of seconds when it can't accept commands.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOST_KEEPALIVE_FEATURE        // Disable this if your host doesn't like keepalive messages
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_KEEPALIVE_INTERVAL 2  // Number of seconds between "busy" messages. Set with M113.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M100 Free Memory Watcher
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define M100_FREE_MEMORY_WATCHER // uncomment to add the M100 Free Memory Watcher for debug purpose
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// G20/G21 Inch mode support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INCH_MODE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// M149 Set temperature units support
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMPERATURE_UNITS_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Preheat Constants
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_HOTEND 180
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_TEMP_BED     70
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_1_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_HOTEND 240
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_TEMP_BED    110
 | 
				
			||||
#define PREHEAT_2_FAN_SPEED     0 // Value from 0 to 255
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Nozzle Park -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to define a special XYZ position, inside the
 | 
				
			||||
// machine's topology, to park the nozzle when idle or when receiving the G27
 | 
				
			||||
// command.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The "P" paramenter controls what is the action applied to the Z axis:
 | 
				
			||||
//    P0: (Default) If current Z-pos is lower than Z-park then the nozzle will
 | 
				
			||||
//        be raised to reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P1: No matter the current Z-pos, the nozzle will be raised/lowered to
 | 
				
			||||
//        reach Z-park height.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//    P2: The nozzle height will be raised by Z-park amount but never going over
 | 
				
			||||
//        the machine's limit of Z_MAX_POS.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_PARK_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify a park position as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_PARK_POINT { (X_MIN_POS + 10), (Y_MAX_POS - 10), 20 }
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Clean Nozzle Feature -- EXPERIMENTAL
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled allows the user to send G12 to start the nozzle cleaning
 | 
				
			||||
// process, the G-Code accepts two parameters:
 | 
				
			||||
//   "P" for pattern selection
 | 
				
			||||
//   "S" for defining the number of strokes/repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Available list of patterns:
 | 
				
			||||
//   P0: This is the default pattern, this process requires a sponge type
 | 
				
			||||
//       material at a fixed bed location. S defines "strokes" i.e.
 | 
				
			||||
//       back-and-forth movements between the starting and end points.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P1: This starts a zig-zag pattern between (X0, Y0) and (X1, Y1), "T"
 | 
				
			||||
//       defines the number of zig-zag triangles to be done. "S" defines the
 | 
				
			||||
//       number of strokes aka one back-and-forth movement. Zig-zags will
 | 
				
			||||
//       be performed in whichever dimension is smallest. As an example,
 | 
				
			||||
//       sending "G12 P1 S1 T3" will execute:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//          --
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y1) |     /\        /\        /\     | (X1, Y1)
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |    /  \      /  \      /  \    |
 | 
				
			||||
//       A |           |   /    \    /    \    /    \   |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |           |  /      \  /      \  /      \  |
 | 
				
			||||
//         |  (X0, Y0) | /        \/        \/        \ | (X1, Y0)
 | 
				
			||||
//          --         +--------------------------------+
 | 
				
			||||
//                       |________|_________|_________|
 | 
				
			||||
//                           T1        T2        T3
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//   P2: This starts a circular pattern with circle with middle in
 | 
				
			||||
//       NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE radius of R and stroke count of S.
 | 
				
			||||
//       Before starting the circle nozzle goes to NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Caveats: End point Z should use the same value as Start point Z.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Attention: This is an EXPERIMENTAL feature, in the future the G-code arguments
 | 
				
			||||
// may change to add new functionality like different wipe patterns.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(NOZZLE_CLEAN_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of pattern repetitions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_STROKES  12
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default number of triangles
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_TRIANGLES  3
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Specify positions as { X, Y, Z }
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT { 30, 30, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_END_POINT   {100, 60, (Z_MIN_POS + 1)}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern radius
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_RADIUS 6.5
 | 
				
			||||
  // Circular pattern circle fragments number
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_FN 10
 | 
				
			||||
  // Middle point of circle
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_CIRCLE_MIDDLE NOZZLE_CLEAN_START_POINT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Moves the nozzle to the initial position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define NOZZLE_CLEAN_GOBACK
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this option to automatically start and stop the
 | 
				
			||||
// print job timer when M104/M109/M190 commands are received.
 | 
				
			||||
// M104 (extruder without wait) - high temp = none, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M109 (extruder with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = stop timer
 | 
				
			||||
// M190 (bed with wait) - high temp = start timer, low temp = none
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// In all cases the timer can be started and stopped using
 | 
				
			||||
// the following commands:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// - M75  - Start the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M76  - Pause the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
// - M77  - Stop the print job timer
 | 
				
			||||
#define PRINTJOB_TIMER_AUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Print Counter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// When enabled Marlin will keep track of some print statistical data such as:
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total successful print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total failed print jobs
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Total time printing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This information can be viewed by the M78 command.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PRINTCOUNTER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================= LCD and SD support ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD LANGUAGE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Here you may choose the language used by Marlin on the LCD menus, the following
 | 
				
			||||
// list of languages are available:
 | 
				
			||||
//    en, an, bg, ca, cn, cz, de, el, el-gr, es, eu, fi, fr, gl, hr, it,
 | 
				
			||||
//    kana, kana_utf8, nl, pl, pt, pt_utf8, pt-br, pt-br_utf8, ru, tr, uk, test
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :{ 'en':'English', 'an':'Aragonese', 'bg':'Bulgarian', 'ca':'Catalan', 'cn':'Chinese', 'cz':'Czech', 'de':'German', 'el':'Greek', 'el-gr':'Greek (Greece)', 'es':'Spanish', 'eu':'Basque-Euskera', 'fi':'Finnish', 'fr':'French', 'gl':'Galician', 'hr':'Croatian', 'it':'Italian', 'kana':'Japanese', 'kana_utf8':'Japanese (UTF8)', 'nl':'Dutch', 'pl':'Polish', 'pt':'Portuguese', 'pt-br':'Portuguese (Brazilian)', 'pt-br_utf8':'Portuguese (Brazilian UTF8)', 'pt_utf8':'Portuguese (UTF8)', 'ru':'Russian', 'tr':'Turkish', 'uk':'Ukrainian', 'test':'TEST' }
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define LCD_LANGUAGE en
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD Character Set
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This option is NOT applicable to Graphical Displays.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// All character-based LCD's provide ASCII plus one of these
 | 
				
			||||
// language extensions:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - JAPANESE ... the most common
 | 
				
			||||
//  - WESTERN  ... with more accented characters
 | 
				
			||||
//  - CYRILLIC ... for the Russian language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// To determine the language extension installed on your controller:
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Compile and upload with LCD_LANGUAGE set to 'test'
 | 
				
			||||
//  - Click the controller to view the LCD menu
 | 
				
			||||
//  - The LCD will display Japanese, Western, or Cyrillic text
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// See https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin/wiki/LCD-Language
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// :['JAPANESE', 'WESTERN', 'CYRILLIC']
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISPLAY_CHARSET_HD44780 JAPANESE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD TYPE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// You may choose ULTRA_LCD if you have character based LCD with 16x2, 16x4, 20x2,
 | 
				
			||||
// 20x4 char/lines or DOGLCD for the full graphics display with 128x64 pixels
 | 
				
			||||
// (ST7565R family). (This option will be set automatically for certain displays.)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// IMPORTANT NOTE: The U8glib library is required for Full Graphic Display!
 | 
				
			||||
//                 https://github.com/olikraus/U8glib_Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTRA_LCD   // Character based
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DOGLCD      // Full graphics display
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD Card support is disabled by default. If your controller has an SD slot,
 | 
				
			||||
// you must uncomment the following option or it won't work.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: SPI SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment ONE of the following items to use a slower SPI transfer
 | 
				
			||||
// speed. This is usually required if you're getting volume init errors.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_HALF_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_QUARTER_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPI_SPEED SPI_EIGHTH_SPEED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SD CARD: ENABLE CRC
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use CRC checks and retries on the SD communication.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SD_CHECK_AND_RETRY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ENCODER SETTINGS
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option overrides the default number of encoder pulses needed to
 | 
				
			||||
// produce one step. Should be increased for high-resolution encoders.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_PULSES_PER_STEP 1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Use this option to override the number of step signals required to
 | 
				
			||||
// move between next/prev menu items.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENCODER_STEPS_PER_MENU_ITEM 5
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Encoder Direction Options
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Test your encoder's behavior first with both options disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Edit and Menu Nav? Enable REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Menu Navigation only?    Enable REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  Reversed Value Editing only?      Enable BOTH options.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction everywhere
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  Set this option if CLOCKWISE causes values to DECREASE
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REVERSE_ENCODER_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// This option reverses the encoder direction for navigating LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves DOWN this makes it go UP.
 | 
				
			||||
//  If CLOCKWISE normally moves UP this makes it go DOWN.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REVERSE_MENU_DIRECTION
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Individual Axis Homing
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Add individual axis homing items (Home X, Home Y, and Home Z) to the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define INDIVIDUAL_AXIS_HOMING_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SPEAKER/BUZZER
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you have a speaker that can produce tones, enable it here.
 | 
				
			||||
// By default Marlin assumes you have a buzzer with a fixed frequency.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SPEAKER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// The duration and frequency for the UI feedback sound.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set these to 0 to disable audio feedback in the LCD menus.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Test audio output with the G-Code:
 | 
				
			||||
//  M300 S<frequency Hz> P<duration ms>
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_DURATION_MS 100
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_FEEDBACK_FREQUENCY_HZ 1000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Standard
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Marlin supports a wide variety of controllers.
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable one of the following options to specify your controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIMAKER Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIMAKERCONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ULTIPANEL as seen on Thingiverse.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ULTIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Cartesio UI
 | 
				
			||||
// http://mauk.cc/webshop/cartesio-shop/electronics/user-interface
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CARTESIO_UI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PanelOne from T3P3 (via RAMPS 1.4 AUX2/AUX3)
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/PanelOne
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PANEL_ONE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MaKr3d Makr-Panel with graphic controller and SD support.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/MaKr3d_MaKrPanel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAKRPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// ReprapWorld Graphical LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// https://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id/1218
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_GRAPHICAL_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Activate one of these if you have a Panucatt Devices
 | 
				
			||||
// Viki 2.0 or mini Viki with Graphic LCD
 | 
				
			||||
// http://panucatt.com
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VIKI2
 | 
				
			||||
//#define miniVIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Adafruit ST7565 Full Graphic Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// https://github.com/eboston/Adafruit-ST7565-Full-Graphic-Controller/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount Smart Controller.
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a white PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// GADGETS3D G3D LCD/SD Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RAMPS_1.3/1.4_GADGETS3D_Shield_with_Panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: Usually sold with a blue PCB.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G3D_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapDiscount FULL GRAPHIC Smart Controller
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprap.org/wiki/RepRapDiscount_Full_Graphic_Smart_Controller
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAP_DISCOUNT_FULL_GRAPHIC_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// MakerLab Mini Panel with graphic
 | 
				
			||||
// controller and SD support - http://reprap.org/wiki/Mini_panel
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MINIPANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RepRapWorld REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD v1.1
 | 
				
			||||
// http://reprapworld.com/?products_details&products_id=202&cPath=1591_1626
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP sets how much should the robot move when a key
 | 
				
			||||
// is pressed, a value of 10.0 means 10mm per click.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD
 | 
				
			||||
//#define REPRAPWORLD_KEYPAD_MOVE_STEP 1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// RigidBot Panel V1.0
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.inventapart.com/
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RIGIDBOT_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// BQ LCD Smart Controller shipped by
 | 
				
			||||
// default with the BQ Hephestos 2 and Witbox 2.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BQ_LCD_SMART_CONTROLLER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: These controllers require the installation of Arduino's LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// library. For more info: https://github.com/kiyoshigawa/LiquidCrystal_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Elefu RA Board Control Panel
 | 
				
			||||
// http://www.elefu.com/index.php?route=product/product&product_id=53
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RA_CONTROL_PANEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Sainsmart YW Robot (LCM1602) LCD Display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_SAINSMART_YWROBOT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Generic LCM1602 LCD adapter
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCM1602
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// PANELOLU2 LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// separate encoder and click inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: This controller requires Arduino's LiquidTWI2 library v1.2.3 or later.
 | 
				
			||||
// For more info: https://github.com/lincomatic/LiquidTWI2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Note: The PANELOLU2 encoder click input can either be directly connected to
 | 
				
			||||
// a pin (if BTN_ENC defined to != -1) or read through I2C (when BTN_ENC == -1).
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_PANELOLU2
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Panucatt VIKI LCD with status LEDs,
 | 
				
			||||
// integrated click & L/R/U/D buttons, separate encoder inputs.
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_I2C_VIKI
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SSD1306 OLED full graphics generic display
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// SAV OLEd LCD module support using either SSD1306 or SH1106 based LCD modules
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SAV_3DGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define U8GLIB_SSD1306
 | 
				
			||||
  #define U8GLIB_SH1106
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// CONTROLLER TYPE: Shift register panels
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// 2 wire Non-latching LCD SR from https://goo.gl/aJJ4sH
 | 
				
			||||
// LCD configuration: http://reprap.org/wiki/SAV_3D_LCD
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SAV_3DLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================== Extra Features ==============================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Increase the FAN PWM frequency. Removes the PWM noise but increases heating in the FET/Arduino
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAST_PWM_FAN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Use software PWM to drive the fan, as for the heaters. This uses a very low frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// which is not as annoying as with the hardware PWM. On the other hand, if this frequency
 | 
				
			||||
// is too low, you should also increment SOFT_PWM_SCALE.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_SOFT_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Incrementing this by 1 will double the software PWM frequency,
 | 
				
			||||
// affecting heaters, and the fan if FAN_SOFT_PWM is enabled.
 | 
				
			||||
// However, control resolution will be halved for each increment;
 | 
				
			||||
// at zero value, there are 128 effective control positions.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SOFT_PWM_SCALE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Temperature status LEDs that display the hotend and bed temperature.
 | 
				
			||||
// If all hotends and bed temperature and temperature setpoint are < 54C then the BLUE led is on.
 | 
				
			||||
// Otherwise the RED led is on. There is 1C hysteresis.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define TEMP_STAT_LEDS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// M240  Triggers a camera by emulating a Canon RC-1 Remote
 | 
				
			||||
// Data from: http://www.doc-diy.net/photo/rc-1_hacked/
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PHOTOGRAPH_PIN     23
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// SkeinForge sends the wrong arc g-codes when using Arc Point as fillet procedure
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SF_ARC_FIX
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for the BariCUDA Paste Extruder.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BARICUDA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//define BlinkM/CyzRgb Support
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BLINKM
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for an RGB LED using 3 separate pins with optional PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define RGB_LED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(RGB_LED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_R_PIN 34
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_G_PIN 43
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RGB_LED_B_PIN 35
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/*********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
* R/C SERVO support
 | 
				
			||||
* Sponsored by TrinityLabs, Reworked by codexmas
 | 
				
			||||
**********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of servos
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// If you select a configuration below, this will receive a default value and does not need to be set manually
 | 
				
			||||
// set it manually if you have more servos than extruders and wish to manually control some
 | 
				
			||||
// leaving it undefined or defining as 0 will disable the servo subsystem
 | 
				
			||||
// If unsure, leave commented / disabled
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NUM_SERVOS 3 // Servo index starts with 0 for M280 command
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Delay (in milliseconds) before the next move will start, to give the servo time to reach its target angle.
 | 
				
			||||
// 300ms is a good value but you can try less delay.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the servo can't reach the requested position, increase it.
 | 
				
			||||
#define SERVO_DELAY 300
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Servo deactivation
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// With this option servos are powered only during movement, then turned off to prevent jitter.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DEACTIVATE_SERVOS_AFTER_MOVE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**********************************************************************\
 | 
				
			||||
 * Support for a filament diameter sensor
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also allows adjustment of diameter at print time (vs  at slicing)
 | 
				
			||||
 * Single extruder only at this point (extruder 0)
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 * 34 - RAMPS1.4 - uses Analog input 5 on the AUX2 connector
 | 
				
			||||
 * 81 - Printrboard - Uses Analog input 2 on the Exp1 connector (version B,C,D,E)
 | 
				
			||||
 * 301 - Rambo  - uses Analog input 3
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note may require analog pins to be defined for different motherboards
 | 
				
			||||
 **********************************************************************/
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment below to enable
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA 3.00  //Enter the diameter (in mm) of the filament generally used (3.0 mm or 1.75 mm) - this is then used in the slicer software.  Used for sensor reading validation
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_WIDTH_SENSOR)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_SENSOR_EXTRUDER_NUM 0   //The number of the extruder that has the filament sensor (0,1,2)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM        14   //measurement delay in cm.  This is the distance from filament sensor to middle of barrel
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_UPPER_LIMIT         3.30  //upper limit factor used for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MEASURED_LOWER_LIMIT         1.90  //lower limit factor for sensor reading validation in mm
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MAX_MEASUREMENT_DELAY       20     //delay buffer size in bytes (1 byte = 1cm)- limits maximum measurement delay allowable (must be larger than MEASUREMENT_DELAY_CM  and lower number saves RAM)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_MEASURED_FILAMENT_DIA  DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA  //set measured to nominal initially
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //When using an LCD, uncomment the line below to display the Filament sensor data on the last line instead of status.  Status will appear for 5 sec.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define FILAMENT_LCD_DISPLAY
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_H
 | 
				
			||||
@ -1,1085 +0,0 @@
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin 3D Printer Firmware
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2016 MarlinFirmware [https://github.com/MarlinFirmware/Marlin]
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Based on Sprinter and grbl.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Copyright (C) 2011 Camiel Gubbels / Erik van der Zalm
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
 | 
				
			||||
 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
 | 
				
			||||
 * the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
 | 
				
			||||
 * (at your option) any later version.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
 | 
				
			||||
 * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
 | 
				
			||||
 * GNU General Public License for more details.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
 | 
				
			||||
 * along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Configuration_adv.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Advanced settings.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Only change these if you know exactly what you're doing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these settings can damage your printer if improperly set!
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Basic settings can be found in Configuration.h
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#ifndef CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *  **  ATTENTION TO ALL DEVELOPERS  **
 | 
				
			||||
 *  ***********************************
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You must increment this version number for every significant change such as,
 | 
				
			||||
 * but not limited to: ADD, DELETE RENAME OR REPURPOSE any directive/option.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Note: Update also Version.h !
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONFIGURATION_ADV_H_VERSION 010100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Thermal Settings  ============================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if DISABLED(PIDTEMPBED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BED_CHECK_INTERVAL 5000 // ms between checks in bang-bang control
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(BED_LIMIT_SWITCHING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Only disable heating if T>target+BED_HYSTERESIS and enable heating if T>target-BED_HYSTERESIS
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection protects your printer from damage and fire if a
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor falls out or temperature sensors fail in any way.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The issue: If a thermistor falls out or a temperature sensor fails,
 | 
				
			||||
 * Marlin can no longer sense the actual temperature. Since a disconnected
 | 
				
			||||
 * thermistor reads as a low temperature, the firmware will keep the heater on.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * The solution: Once the temperature reaches the target, start observing.
 | 
				
			||||
 * If the temperature stays too far below the target (hysteresis) for too long (period),
 | 
				
			||||
 * the firmware will halt the machine as a safety precaution.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you get false positives for "Thermal Runaway" increase THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS and/or THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_HOTENDS)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_PERIOD 40        // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_HYSTERESIS 4     // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M104 or M109 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M104/M109,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get false positives for "Heating failed" increase WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_PERIOD 20                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermal Protection parameters for the bed are just as above for hotends.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_PERIOD 20    // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define THERMAL_PROTECTION_BED_HYSTERESIS 2 // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Whenever an M140 or M190 increases the target temperature the firmware will wait for the
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD to expire, and if the temperature hasn't increased by WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE
 | 
				
			||||
   * degrees, the machine is halted, requiring a hard reset. This test restarts with any M140/M190,
 | 
				
			||||
   * but only if the current temperature is far enough below the target for a reliable test.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * If you get too many "Heating failed" errors, increase WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD and/or decrease
 | 
				
			||||
   * WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE. (WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE should not be below 2.)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_PERIOD 60                // Seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define WATCH_BED_TEMP_INCREASE 2               // Degrees Celsius
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(PIDTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  // this adds an experimental additional term to the heating power, proportional to the extrusion speed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if Kc is chosen well, the additional required power due to increased melting should be compensated.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(PID_EXTRUSION_SCALING)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define DEFAULT_Kc (100) //heating power=Kc*(e_speed)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define LPQ_MAX_LEN 50
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Automatic Temperature:
 | 
				
			||||
 * The hotend target temperature is calculated by all the buffered lines of gcode.
 | 
				
			||||
 * The maximum buffered steps/sec of the extruder motor is called "se".
 | 
				
			||||
 * Start autotemp mode with M109 S<mintemp> B<maxtemp> F<factor>
 | 
				
			||||
 * The target temperature is set to mintemp+factor*se[steps/sec] and is limited by
 | 
				
			||||
 * mintemp and maxtemp. Turn this off by executing M109 without F*
 | 
				
			||||
 * Also, if the temperature is set to a value below mintemp, it will not be changed by autotemp.
 | 
				
			||||
 * On an Ultimaker, some initial testing worked with M109 S215 B260 F1 in the start.gcode
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define AUTOTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTOTEMP)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTOTEMP_OLDWEIGHT 0.98
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//Show Temperature ADC value
 | 
				
			||||
//The M105 command return, besides traditional information, the ADC value read from temperature sensors.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define SHOW_TEMP_ADC_VALUES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * High Temperature Thermistor Support
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Thermistors able to support high temperature tend to have a hard time getting
 | 
				
			||||
 * good readings at room and lower temperatures. This means HEATER_X_RAW_LO_TEMP
 | 
				
			||||
 * will probably be caught when the heating element first turns on during the
 | 
				
			||||
 * preheating process, which will trigger a min_temp_error as a safety measure
 | 
				
			||||
 * and force stop everything.
 | 
				
			||||
 * To circumvent this limitation, we allow for a preheat time (during which,
 | 
				
			||||
 * min_temp_error won't be triggered) and add a min_temp buffer to handle
 | 
				
			||||
 * aberrant readings.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * If you want to enable this feature for your hotend thermistor(s)
 | 
				
			||||
 * uncomment and set values > 0 in the constants below
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of consecutive low temperature errors that can occur
 | 
				
			||||
// before a min_temp_error is triggered. (Shouldn't be more than 10.)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MAX_CONSECUTIVE_LOW_TEMPERATURE_ERROR_ALLOWED 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of milliseconds a hotend will preheat before starting to check
 | 
				
			||||
// the temperature. This value should NOT be set to the time it takes the
 | 
				
			||||
// hot end to reach the target temperature, but the time it takes to reach
 | 
				
			||||
// the minimum temperature your thermistor can read. The lower the better/safer.
 | 
				
			||||
// This shouldn't need to be more than 30 seconds (30000)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define MILLISECONDS_PREHEAT_TIME 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Extruder runout prevention.
 | 
				
			||||
// If the machine is idle and the temperature over MINTEMP
 | 
				
			||||
// then extrude some filament every couple of SECONDS.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_PREVENT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_MINTEMP 190
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SECONDS 30
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_SPEED 1500  // mm/m
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_RUNOUT_EXTRUDE 5   // mm
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//These defines help to calibrate the AD595 sensor in case you get wrong temperature measurements.
 | 
				
			||||
//The measured temperature is defined as "actualTemp = (measuredTemp * TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN) + TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET"
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_OFFSET 0.0
 | 
				
			||||
#define TEMP_SENSOR_AD595_GAIN   1.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//This is for controlling a fan to cool down the stepper drivers
 | 
				
			||||
//it will turn on when any driver is enabled
 | 
				
			||||
//and turn off after the set amount of seconds from last driver being disabled again
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_PIN -1 //Pin used for the fan to cool controller (-1 to disable)
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SECS 60 //How many seconds, after all motors were disabled, the fan should run
 | 
				
			||||
#define CONTROLLERFAN_SPEED 255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When first starting the main fan, run it at full speed for the
 | 
				
			||||
// given number of milliseconds.  This gets the fan spinning reliably
 | 
				
			||||
// before setting a PWM value. (Does not work with software PWM for fan on Sanguinololu)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_KICKSTART_TIME 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// This defines the minimal speed for the main fan, run in PWM mode
 | 
				
			||||
// to enable uncomment and set minimal PWM speed for reliable running (1-255)
 | 
				
			||||
// if fan speed is [1 - (FAN_MIN_PWM-1)] it is set to FAN_MIN_PWM
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FAN_MIN_PWM 50
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder cooling fans
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Extruder auto fans automatically turn on when their extruders'
 | 
				
			||||
 * temperatures go above EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Your board's pins file specifies the recommended pins. Override those here
 | 
				
			||||
 * or set to -1 to disable completely.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Multiple extruders can be assigned to the same pin in which case
 | 
				
			||||
 * the fan will turn on when any selected extruder is above the threshold.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#define E0_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E1_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E2_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define E3_AUTO_FAN_PIN -1
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_TEMPERATURE 50
 | 
				
			||||
#define EXTRUDER_AUTO_FAN_SPEED   255  // == full speed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Define a pin to turn case light on/off
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CASE_LIGHT_PIN 4
 | 
				
			||||
#if PIN_EXISTS(CASE_LIGHT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_CASE_LIGHT false   // Set to true if HIGH is the OFF state (active low)
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define CASE_LIGHT_DEFAULT_ON   // Uncomment to set default state to on
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ITEM_CASE_LIGHT    // Uncomment to have a Case Light On / Off entry in main menu
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//============================ Mechanical Settings ==========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If you want endstops to stay on (by default) even when not homing
 | 
				
			||||
// enable this option. Override at any time with M120, M121.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ENDSTOPS_ALWAYS_ON_DEFAULT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_LATE_ENABLE // Enable Z the last moment. Needed if your Z driver overheats.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual X Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two X axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second X stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(X_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two X motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_X2_VS_X_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Dual Y Steppers
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to drive two Y axis motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Y stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Y_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Set true if the two Y motors need to rotate in opposite directions
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INVERT_Y2_VS_Y_DIR true
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// A single Z stepper driver is usually used to drive 2 stepper motors.
 | 
				
			||||
// Uncomment this option to use a separate stepper driver for each Z axis motor.
 | 
				
			||||
// The next unused E driver will be assigned to the second Z stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS is a feature to enable the use of 2 endstops for both Z steppers - Let's call them Z stepper and Z2 stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
  // That way the machine is capable to align the bed during home, since both Z steppers are homed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // There is also an implementation of M666 (software endstops adjustment) to this feature.
 | 
				
			||||
  // After Z homing, this adjustment is applied to just one of the steppers in order to align the bed.
 | 
				
			||||
  // One just need to home the Z axis and measure the distance difference between both Z axis and apply the math: Z adjust = Z - Z2.
 | 
				
			||||
  // If the Z stepper axis is closer to the bed, the measure Z > Z2 (yes, it is.. think about it) and the Z adjust would be positive.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Play a little bit with small adjustments (0.5mm) and check the behaviour.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The M119 (endstops report) will start reporting the Z2 Endstop as well.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(Z_DUAL_ENDSTOPS)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define Z2_USE_ENDSTOP _XMAX_
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // Z_DUAL_STEPPER_DRIVERS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable this for dual x-carriage printers.
 | 
				
			||||
// A dual x-carriage design has the advantage that the inactive extruder can be parked which
 | 
				
			||||
// prevents hot-end ooze contaminating the print. It also reduces the weight of each x-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
// allowing faster printing speeds. Connect your X2 stepper to the first unused E plug.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DUAL_X_CARRIAGE)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Configuration for second X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: the first x-carriage is defined as the x-carriage which homes to the minimum endstop;
 | 
				
			||||
  // the second x-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MIN_POS 80     // set minimum to ensure second x-carriage doesn't hit the parked first X-carriage
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_POS 353    // set maximum to the distance between toolheads when both heads are homed
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_DIR 1     // the second X-carriage always homes to the maximum endstop position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_HOME_POS X2_MAX_POS // default home position is the maximum carriage position
 | 
				
			||||
      // However: In this mode the HOTEND_OFFSET_X value for the second extruder provides a software
 | 
				
			||||
      // override for X2_HOME_POS. This also allow recalibration of the distance between the two endstops
 | 
				
			||||
      // without modifying the firmware (through the "M218 T1 X???" command).
 | 
				
			||||
      // Remember: you should set the second extruder x-offset to 0 in your slicer.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // There are a few selectable movement modes for dual x-carriages using M605 S<mode>
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 0 (DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE): Full control. The slicer has full control over both x-carriages and can achieve optimal travel results
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    as long as it supports dual x-carriages. (M605 S0)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 1 (DXC_AUTO_PARK_MODE)   : Auto-park mode. The firmware will automatically park and unpark the x-carriages on tool changes so
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    that additional slicer support is not required. (M605 S1)
 | 
				
			||||
  //    Mode 2 (DXC_DUPLICATION_MODE) : Duplication mode. The firmware will transparently make the second x-carriage and extruder copy all
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    actions of the first x-carriage. This allows the printer to print 2 arbitrary items at
 | 
				
			||||
  //                                    once. (2nd extruder x offset and temp offset are set using: M605 S2 [Xnnn] [Rmmm])
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This is the default power-up mode which can be later using M605.
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUAL_X_CARRIAGE_MODE DXC_FULL_CONTROL_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default settings in "Auto-park Mode"
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_PARK_ZLIFT   0.2      // the distance to raise Z axis when parking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
  #define TOOLCHANGE_UNPARK_ZLIFT 1        // the distance to raise Z axis when unparking an extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Default x offset in duplication mode (typically set to half print bed width)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define DEFAULT_DUPLICATION_X_OFFSET 100
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif //DUAL_X_CARRIAGE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section homing
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//homing hits the endstop, then retracts by this distance, before it tries to slowly bump again:
 | 
				
			||||
#define X_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Y_HOME_BUMP_MM 5
 | 
				
			||||
#define Z_HOME_BUMP_MM 2
 | 
				
			||||
#define HOMING_BUMP_DIVISOR {2, 2, 4}  // Re-Bump Speed Divisor (Divides the Homing Feedrate)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define QUICK_HOME  //if this is defined, if both x and y are to be homed, a diagonal move will be performed initially.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// When G28 is called, this option will make Y home before X
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HOME_Y_BEFORE_X
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section machine
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define AXIS_RELATIVE_MODES {false, false, false, false}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Allow duplication mode with a basic dual-nozzle extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DUAL_NOZZLE_DUPLICATION_MODE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// By default pololu step drivers require an active high signal. However, some high power drivers require an active low signal as step.
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_X_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Y_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_Z_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
#define INVERT_E_STEP_PIN false
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default stepper release if idle. Set to 0 to deactivate.
 | 
				
			||||
// Steppers will shut down DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME seconds after the last move when DISABLE_INACTIVE_? is true.
 | 
				
			||||
// Time can be set by M18 and M84.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME 120
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_X true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Y true
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_Z true  // set to false if the nozzle will fall down on your printed part when print has finished.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DISABLE_INACTIVE_E true
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINIMUMFEEDRATE       0.0     // minimum feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINTRAVELFEEDRATE     0.0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ULTIPANEL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MANUAL_FEEDRATE {50*60, 50*60, 4*60, 60} // Feedrates for manual moves along X, Y, Z, E from panel
 | 
				
			||||
  #define ULTIPANEL_FEEDMULTIPLY  // Comment to disable setting feedrate multiplier via encoder
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// minimum time in microseconds that a movement needs to take if the buffer is emptied.
 | 
				
			||||
#define DEFAULT_MINSEGMENTTIME        20000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// If defined the movements slow down when the look ahead buffer is only half full
 | 
				
			||||
#define SLOWDOWN
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Frequency limit
 | 
				
			||||
// See nophead's blog for more info
 | 
				
			||||
// Not working O
 | 
				
			||||
//#define XY_FREQUENCY_LIMIT  15
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Minimum planner junction speed. Sets the default minimum speed the planner plans for at the end
 | 
				
			||||
// of the buffer and all stops. This should not be much greater than zero and should only be changed
 | 
				
			||||
// if unwanted behavior is observed on a user's machine when running at very slow speeds.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_PLANNER_SPEED 0.05// (mm/sec)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Microstep setting (Only functional when stepper driver microstep pins are connected to MCU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MICROSTEP_MODES {16,16,16,16,16} // [1,2,4,8,16]
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current setting (Only functional when motor driver current ref pins are connected to a digital trimpot on supported boards)
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_MOTOR_CURRENT {135,135,135,135,135} // Values 0-255 (RAMBO 135 = ~0.75A, 185 = ~1A)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Motor Current controlled via PWM (Overridable on supported boards with PWM-driven motor driver current)
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PWM_MOTOR_CURRENT {1300, 1300, 1250} // Values in milliamps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// uncomment to enable an I2C based DIGIPOT like on the Azteeg X3 Pro
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DIGIPOT_I2C
 | 
				
			||||
// Number of channels available for I2C digipot, For Azteeg X3 Pro we have 8
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS 8
 | 
				
			||||
// actual motor currents in Amps, need as many here as DIGIPOT_I2C_NUM_CHANNELS
 | 
				
			||||
#define DIGIPOT_I2C_MOTOR_CURRENTS {1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0, 1.0}
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//=============================Additional Features===========================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_RATE_MULTIPLIER         // If defined, certain menu edit operations automatically multiply the steps when the encoder is moved quickly
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_10X_STEPS_PER_SEC 75    // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x10 to quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
#define ENCODER_100X_STEPS_PER_SEC 160  // If the encoder steps per sec exceeds this value, multiply steps moved x100 to really quickly advance the value
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define CHDK 4        //Pin for triggering CHDK to take a picture see how to use it here http://captain-slow.dk/2014/03/09/3d-printing-timelapses/
 | 
				
			||||
#define CHDK_DELAY 50 //How long in ms the pin should stay HIGH before going LOW again
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Include a page of printer information in the LCD Main Menu
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_INFO_MENU
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// On the Info Screen, display XY with one decimal place when possible
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_DECIMAL_SMALL_XY
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The timeout (in ms) to return to the status screen from sub-menus
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LCD_TIMEOUT_TO_STATUS 15000
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Some RAMPS and other boards don't detect when an SD card is inserted. You can work
 | 
				
			||||
  // around this by connecting a push button or single throw switch to the pin defined
 | 
				
			||||
  // as SD_DETECT_PIN in your board's pins definitions.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This setting should be disabled unless you are using a push button, pulling the pin to ground.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Note: This is always disabled for ULTIPANEL (except ELB_FULL_GRAPHIC_CONTROLLER).
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_DETECT_INVERTED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_STEPPERRELEASE true  //if sd support and the file is finished: disable steppers?
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SD_FINISHED_RELEASECOMMAND "M84 X Y Z E" // You might want to keep the z enabled so your bed stays in place.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define SDCARD_RATHERRECENTFIRST  //reverse file order of sd card menu display. Its sorted practically after the file system block order.
 | 
				
			||||
  // if a file is deleted, it frees a block. hence, the order is not purely chronological. To still have auto0.g accessible, there is again the option to do that.
 | 
				
			||||
  // using:
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define MENU_ADDAUTOSTART
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Sort SD file listings in alphabetical order.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * With this option enabled, items on SD cards will be sorted
 | 
				
			||||
   * by name for easier navigation.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * By default...
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Use the slowest -but safest- method for sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - Folders are sorted to the top.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - The sort key is statically allocated.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - No added G-code (M34) support.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - 40 item sorting limit. (Items after the first 40 are unsorted.)
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * SD sorting uses static allocation (as set by SDSORT_LIMIT), allowing the
 | 
				
			||||
   * compiler to calculate the worst-case usage and throw an error if the SRAM
 | 
				
			||||
   * limit is exceeded.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_RAM provides faster sorting via a static directory buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_USES_STACK does the same, but uses a local stack-based buffer.
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES will retain the sorted file listing in RAM. (Expensive!)
 | 
				
			||||
   *  - SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM only uses RAM when the SD menu is visible. (Use with caution!)
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // SD Card Sorting options
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(SDCARD_SORT_ALPHA)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_LIMIT       40     // Maximum number of sorted items (10-256).
 | 
				
			||||
    #define FOLDER_SORTING     -1     // -1=above  0=none  1=below
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_GCODE       false  // Allow turning sorting on/off with LCD and M34 g-code.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_RAM    false  // Pre-allocate a static array for faster pre-sorting.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_USES_STACK  false  // Prefer the stack for pre-sorting to give back some SRAM. (Negated by next 2 options.)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_CACHE_NAMES false  // Keep sorted items in RAM longer for speedy performance. Most expensive option.
 | 
				
			||||
    #define SDSORT_DYNAMIC_RAM false  // Use dynamic allocation (within SD menus). Least expensive option. Set SDSORT_LIMIT before use!
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Show a progress bar on HD44780 LCDs for SD printing
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #if ENABLED(LCD_PROGRESS_BAR)
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the bar
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_BAR_TIME 2000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to show the status message
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_BAR_MSG_TIME 3000
 | 
				
			||||
    // Amount of time (ms) to retain the status message (0=forever)
 | 
				
			||||
    #define PROGRESS_MSG_EXPIRE   0
 | 
				
			||||
    // Enable this to show messages for MSG_TIME then hide them
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define PROGRESS_MSG_ONCE
 | 
				
			||||
    // Add a menu item to test the progress bar:
 | 
				
			||||
    //#define LCD_PROGRESS_BAR_TEST
 | 
				
			||||
  #endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This allows hosts to request long names for files and folders with M33
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define LONG_FILENAME_HOST_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // This option allows you to abort SD printing when any endstop is triggered.
 | 
				
			||||
  // This feature must be enabled with "M540 S1" or from the LCD menu.
 | 
				
			||||
  // To have any effect, endstops must be enabled during SD printing.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define ABORT_ON_ENDSTOP_HIT_FEATURE_ENABLED
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // SDSUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Additional options for Graphical Displays
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Use the optimizations here to improve printing performance,
 | 
				
			||||
 * which can be adversely affected by graphical display drawing,
 | 
				
			||||
 * especially when doing several short moves, and when printing
 | 
				
			||||
 * on DELTA and SCARA machines.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Some of these options may result in the display lagging behind
 | 
				
			||||
 * controller events, as there is a trade-off between reliable
 | 
				
			||||
 * printing performance versus fast display updates.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(DOGLCD)
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on the Info Screen
 | 
				
			||||
  #define XYZ_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable to save many cycles by drawing a hollow frame on Menu Screens
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MENU_HOLLOW_FRAME
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A bigger font is available for edit items. Costs 3120 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_BIG_EDIT_FONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // A smaller font may be used on the Info Screen. Costs 2300 bytes of PROGMEM.
 | 
				
			||||
  // Western only. Not available for Cyrillic, Kana, Turkish, Greek, or Chinese.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define USE_SMALL_INFOFONT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // Enable this option and reduce the value to optimize screen updates.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The normal delay is 10µs. Use the lowest value that still gives a reliable display.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define DOGM_SPI_DELAY_US 5
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // DOGLCD
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section safety
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The hardware watchdog should reset the microcontroller disabling all outputs,
 | 
				
			||||
// in case the firmware gets stuck and doesn't do temperature regulation.
 | 
				
			||||
#define USE_WATCHDOG
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(USE_WATCHDOG)
 | 
				
			||||
  // If you have a watchdog reboot in an ArduinoMega2560 then the device will hang forever, as a watchdog reset will leave the watchdog on.
 | 
				
			||||
  // The "WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL" goes around this by not using the hardware reset.
 | 
				
			||||
  //  However, THIS FEATURE IS UNSAFE!, as it will only work if interrupts are disabled. And the code could hang in an interrupt routine with interrupts disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define WATCHDOG_RESET_MANUAL
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section lcd
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Babystepping enables the user to control the axis in tiny amounts, independently from the normal printing process
 | 
				
			||||
// it can e.g. be used to change z-positions in the print startup phase in real-time
 | 
				
			||||
// does not respect endstops!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(BABYSTEPPING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_XY  //not only z, but also XY in the menu. more clutter, more functions
 | 
				
			||||
                       //not implemented for deltabots!
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_INVERT_Z false  //true for inverse movements in Z
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BABYSTEP_MULTIPLICATOR 1 //faster movements
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extruder
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// extruder advance constant (s2/mm3)
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// advance (steps) = STEPS_PER_CUBIC_MM_E * EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K * cubic mm per second ^ 2
 | 
				
			||||
//
 | 
				
			||||
// Hooke's law says:    force = k * distance
 | 
				
			||||
// Bernoulli's principle says:  v ^ 2 / 2 + g . h + pressure / density = constant
 | 
				
			||||
// so: v ^ 2 is proportional to number of steps we advance the extruder
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define EXTRUDER_ADVANCE_K .0
 | 
				
			||||
  #define D_FILAMENT 2.85
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Implementation of linear pressure control
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Assumption: advance = k * (delta velocity)
 | 
				
			||||
 * K=0 means advance disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 * See Marlin documentation for calibration instructions.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define LIN_ADVANCE
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(LIN_ADVANCE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_K 75
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Some Slicers produce Gcode with randomly jumping extrusion widths occasionally.
 | 
				
			||||
   * For example within a 0.4mm perimeter it may produce a single segment of 0.05mm width.
 | 
				
			||||
   * While this is harmless for normal printing (the fluid nature of the filament will
 | 
				
			||||
   * close this very, very tiny gap), it throws off the LIN_ADVANCE pressure adaption.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * For this case LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO can be used to set the extrusion:distance ratio
 | 
				
			||||
   * to a fixed value. Note that using a fixed ratio will lead to wrong nozzle pressures
 | 
				
			||||
   * if the slicer is using variable widths or layer heights within one print!
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * This option sets the default E:D ratio at startup. Use `M905` to override this value.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example: `M905 W0.4 H0.2 D1.75`, where:
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - W is the extrusion width in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - H is the layer height in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *   - D is the filament diameter in mm
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Set to 0 to auto-detect the ratio based on given Gcode G1 print moves.
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Slic3r (including Prusa Slic3r) produces Gcode compatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Cura (as of this writing) may produce Gcode incompatible with the automatic mode.
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define LIN_ADVANCE_E_D_RATIO 0 // The calculated ratio (or 0) according to the formula W * H / ((D / 2) ^ 2 * PI)
 | 
				
			||||
                                  // Example: 0.4 * 0.2 / ((1.75 / 2) ^ 2 * PI) = 0.033260135
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section leveling
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Default mesh area is an area with an inset margin on the print area.
 | 
				
			||||
// Below are the macros that are used to define the borders for the mesh area,
 | 
				
			||||
// made available here for specialized needs, ie dual extruder setup.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(MESH_BED_LEVELING)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(AUTO_BED_LEVELING_UBL)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_X (X_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_X (X_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MIN_Y (Y_MIN_POS + UBL_MESH_INSET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define UBL_MESH_MAX_Y (Y_MAX_POS - (UBL_MESH_INSET))
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section extras
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Arc interpretation settings:
 | 
				
			||||
#define ARC_SUPPORT  // Disabling this saves ~2738 bytes
 | 
				
			||||
#define MM_PER_ARC_SEGMENT 1
 | 
				
			||||
#define N_ARC_CORRECTION 25
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Support for G5 with XYZE destination and IJPQ offsets. Requires ~2666 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define BEZIER_CURVE_SUPPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// G38.2 and G38.3 Probe Target
 | 
				
			||||
//#define G38_PROBE_TARGET
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(G38_PROBE_TARGET)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define G38_MINIMUM_MOVE 0.0275 // minimum distance in mm that will produce a move (determined using the print statement in check_move)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Moves (or segments) with fewer steps than this will be joined with the next move
 | 
				
			||||
#define MIN_STEPS_PER_SEGMENT 6
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The minimum pulse width (in µs) for stepping a stepper.
 | 
				
			||||
// Set this if you find stepping unreliable, or if using a very fast CPU.
 | 
				
			||||
#define MINIMUM_STEPPER_PULSE 0 // (µs) The smallest stepper pulse allowed
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section temperature
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Control heater 0 and heater 1 in parallel.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HEATERS_PARALLEL
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
//================================= Buffers =================================
 | 
				
			||||
//===========================================================================
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section hidden
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The number of linear motions that can be in the plan at any give time.
 | 
				
			||||
// THE BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE NEEDS TO BE A POWER OF 2, i.g. 8,16,32 because shifts and ors are used to do the ring-buffering.
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(SDSUPPORT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // SD,LCD,Buttons take more memory, block buffer needs to be smaller
 | 
				
			||||
#else
 | 
				
			||||
  #define BLOCK_BUFFER_SIZE 16 // maximize block buffer
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section serial
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// The ASCII buffer for serial input
 | 
				
			||||
#define MAX_CMD_SIZE 96
 | 
				
			||||
#define BUFSIZE 4
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Transfer Buffer Size
 | 
				
			||||
// To save 386 bytes of PROGMEM (and TX_BUFFER_SIZE+3 bytes of RAM) set to 0.
 | 
				
			||||
// To buffer a simple "ok" you need 4 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For ADVANCED_OK (M105) you need 32 bytes.
 | 
				
			||||
// For debug-echo: 128 bytes for the optimal speed.
 | 
				
			||||
// Other output doesn't need to be that speedy.
 | 
				
			||||
// :[0, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, 128, 256]
 | 
				
			||||
#define TX_BUFFER_SIZE 0
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Enable an emergency-command parser to intercept certain commands as they
 | 
				
			||||
// enter the serial receive buffer, so they cannot be blocked.
 | 
				
			||||
// Currently handles M108, M112, M410
 | 
				
			||||
// Does not work on boards using AT90USB (USBCON) processors!
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EMERGENCY_PARSER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Bad Serial-connections can miss a received command by sending an 'ok'
 | 
				
			||||
// Therefore some clients abort after 30 seconds in a timeout.
 | 
				
			||||
// Some other clients start sending commands while receiving a 'wait'.
 | 
				
			||||
// This "wait" is only sent when the buffer is empty. 1 second is a good value here.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_TIMEOUTS 1000 // Milliseconds
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Some clients will have this feature soon. This could make the NO_TIMEOUTS unnecessary.
 | 
				
			||||
//#define ADVANCED_OK
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section fwretract
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// Firmware based and LCD controlled retract
 | 
				
			||||
// M207 and M208 can be used to define parameters for the retraction.
 | 
				
			||||
// The retraction can be called by the slicer using G10 and G11
 | 
				
			||||
// until then, intended retractions can be detected by moves that only extrude and the direction.
 | 
				
			||||
// the moves are than replaced by the firmware controlled ones.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FWRETRACT  //ONLY PARTIALLY TESTED
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FWRETRACT)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define MIN_RETRACT 0.1                //minimum extruded mm to accept a automatic gcode retraction attempt
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH 3               //default retract length (positive mm)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_LENGTH_SWAP 13         //default swap retract length (positive mm), for extruder change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_FEEDRATE 45            //default feedrate for retracting (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_ZLIFT 0                //default retract Z-lift
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH 0       //default additional recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_LENGTH_SWAP 0  //default additional swap recover length (mm, added to retract length when recovering from extruder change)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define RETRACT_RECOVER_FEEDRATE 8     //default feedrate for recovering from retraction (mm/s)
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Filament Change
 | 
				
			||||
 * Experimental filament change support.
 | 
				
			||||
 * Adds the GCode M600 for initiating filament change.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * Requires an LCD display.
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is required for the default FILAMENT_RUNOUT_SCRIPT.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(FILAMENT_CHANGE_FEATURE)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_X_POS 3             // X position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Y_POS 3             // Y position of hotend
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_ADD 10            // Z addition of hotend (lift)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_XY_FEEDRATE 100     // X and Y axes feedrate in mm/s (also used for delta printers Z axis)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_Z_FEEDRATE 5        // Z axis feedrate in mm/s (not used for delta printers)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_FEEDRATE 60 // Initial retract feedrate in mm/s
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_RETRACT_LENGTH 2    // Initial retract in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // It is a short retract used immediately after print interrupt before move to filament exchange position
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_FEEDRATE 10  // Unload filament feedrate in mm/s - filament unloading can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_UNLOAD_LENGTH 100   // Unload filament length from hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to unload filament from whole bowden tube,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // shorter length for printers without bowden to unload filament from extruder only,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable unloading for manual unloading
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_FEEDRATE 6     // Load filament feedrate in mm/s - filament loading into the bowden tube can be fast
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_LOAD_LENGTH 0       // Load filament length over hotend in mm
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Longer length for bowden printers to fast load filament into whole bowden tube over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Short or zero length for printers without bowden where loading is not used
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_FEEDRATE 3  // Extrude filament feedrate in mm/s - must be slower than load feedrate
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_EXTRUDE_LENGTH 50   // Extrude filament length in mm after filament is loaded over the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // 0 to disable for manual extrusion
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // Filament can be extruded repeatedly from the filament exchange menu to fill the hotend,
 | 
				
			||||
                                              // or until outcoming filament color is not clear for filament color change
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NOZZLE_TIMEOUT 45L  // Turn off nozzle if user doesn't change filament within this time limit in seconds
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NUMBER_OF_ALERT_BEEPS  5L  // Number of alert beeps before printer goes quiet
 | 
				
			||||
  #define FILAMENT_CHANGE_NO_STEPPER_TIMEOUT         // Enable to have stepper motors hold position during filament change
 | 
				
			||||
                                                     // even if it takes longer than DEFAULT_STEPPER_DEACTIVE_TIME.
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section tmc
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have TMC26X motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You will need to import the TMC26XStepper library into the Arduino IDE for this
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/trinamic/TMC26XStepper.git)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMCDRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMCDRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000 // in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_SENSE_RESISTOR    91 // in mOhms
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_SENSE_RESISTOR    91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MAX_CURRENT    1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_SENSE_RESISTOR   91
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS       16
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this for SilentStepStick Trinamic TMC2130 SPI-configurable stepper drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * You'll also need the TMC2130Stepper Arduino library
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper).
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * To use TMC2130 stepper drivers in SPI mode connect your SPI2130 pins to
 | 
				
			||||
 * the hardware SPI interface on your board and define the required CS pins
 | 
				
			||||
 * in your `pins_MYBOARD.h` file. (e.g., RAMPS 1.4 uses AUX3 pins `X_CS_PIN 53`, `Y_CS_PIN 49`, etc.).
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
  #define STEALTHCHOP
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Let Marlin automatically control stepper current.
 | 
				
			||||
   * This is still an experimental feature.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Increase current every 5s by CURRENT_STEP until stepper temperature prewarn gets triggered,
 | 
				
			||||
   * then decrease current by CURRENT_STEP until temperature prewarn is cleared.
 | 
				
			||||
   * Adjusting starts from X/Y/Z/E_MAX_CURRENT but will not increase over AUTO_ADJUST_MAX
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define AUTOMATIC_CURRENT_CONTROL
 | 
				
			||||
  #define CURRENT_STEP          50  // [mA]
 | 
				
			||||
  #define AUTO_ADJUST_MAX     1300  // [mA], 1300mA_rms = 1840mA_peak
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  // CHOOSE YOUR MOTORS HERE, THIS IS MANDATORY
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_TMC2130
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * Stepper driver settings
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define R_SENSE           0.11  // R_sense resistor for SilentStepStick2130
 | 
				
			||||
  #define HOLD_MULTIPLIER    0.5  // Scales down the holding current from run current
 | 
				
			||||
  #define INTERPOLATE          1  // Interpolate X/Y/Z_MICROSTEPS to 256
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MAX_CURRENT     1000  // rms current in mA
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS        16  // FULLSTEP..256
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_CHIP_SELECT       40  // Pin
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_CHIP_SELECT       42
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MAX_CURRENT     1000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS        16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_CHIP_SELECT       65
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MAX_CURRENT  1000
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_CHIP_SELECT    -1
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  /**
 | 
				
			||||
   * You can set your own advanced settings by filling in predefined functions.
 | 
				
			||||
   * A list of available functions can be found on the library github page
 | 
				
			||||
   * https://github.com/teemuatlut/TMC2130Stepper
 | 
				
			||||
   *
 | 
				
			||||
   * Example:
 | 
				
			||||
   * #define TMC2130_ADV() { \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.diag0_temp_prewarn(1); \
 | 
				
			||||
   *   stepperX.interpolate(0); \
 | 
				
			||||
   * }
 | 
				
			||||
   */
 | 
				
			||||
  #define  TMC2130_ADV() {  }
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // ENABLED(HAVE_TMC2130)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this section if you have L6470 motor drivers.
 | 
				
			||||
 * You need to import the L6470 library into the Arduino IDE for this.
 | 
				
			||||
 * (https://github.com/ameyer/Arduino-L6470)
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section l6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define HAVE_L6470DRIVER
 | 
				
			||||
#if ENABLED(HAVE_L6470DRIVER)
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define X2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Y2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define Z2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E0_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E1_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E2_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
  //#define E3_IS_L6470
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_MICROSTEPS      16 // number of microsteps
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_K_VAL           50 // 0 - 255, Higher values, are higher power. Be careful not to go too high
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_OVERCURRENT   2000 // maxc current in mA. If the current goes over this value, the driver will switch off
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X_STALLCURRENT  1500 // current in mA where the driver will detect a stall
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define X2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Y2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_MICROSTEPS      16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_K_VAL           50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_OVERCURRENT   2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z_STALLCURRENT  1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define Z2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E0_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E1_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E2_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_MICROSTEPS     16
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_K_VAL          50
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_OVERCURRENT  2000
 | 
				
			||||
  #define E3_STALLCURRENT 1500
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * TWI/I2C BUS
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * This feature is an EXPERIMENTAL feature so it shall not be used on production
 | 
				
			||||
 * machines. Enabling this will allow you to send and receive I2C data from slave
 | 
				
			||||
 * devices on the bus.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #1
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; This macro send the string "Marlin" to the slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; It uses multiple M260 commands with one B<base 10> arg
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 A99  ; Target slave address
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B77  ; M
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B97  ; a
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B114 ; r
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B108 ; l
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B105 ; i
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 B110 ; n
 | 
				
			||||
 * M260 S1   ; Send the current buffer
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #2
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Request 6 bytes from slave device with address 0x63 (99)
 | 
				
			||||
 * M261 A99 B5
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example #3
 | 
				
			||||
 * ; Example serial output of a M261 request
 | 
				
			||||
 * echo:i2c-reply: from:99 bytes:5 data:hello
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
// @section i2cbus
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXPERIMENTAL_I2CBUS
 | 
				
			||||
#define I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS  0 // Set a value from 8 to 127 to act as a slave
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Add M43, M44 and M45 commands for pins info and testing
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define PINS_DEBUGGING
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Auto-report temperatures with M155 S<seconds>
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define AUTO_REPORT_TEMPERATURES
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Include capabilities in M115 output
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define EXTENDED_CAPABILITIES_REPORT
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Double-click the Encoder button on the Status Screen for Z Babystepping.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define DOUBLECLICK_FOR_Z_BABYSTEPPING
 | 
				
			||||
#define DOUBLECLICK_MAX_INTERVAL 1250   // Maximum interval between clicks, in milliseconds.
 | 
				
			||||
                                        // Note: You may need to add extra time to mitigate controller latency.
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Volumetric extrusion default state
 | 
				
			||||
 * Activate to make volumetric extrusion the default method,
 | 
				
			||||
 * with DEFAULT_NOMINAL_FILAMENT_DIA as the default diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 * M200 D0 to disable, M200 Dn to set a new diameter.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define VOLUMETRIC_DEFAULT_ON
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
/**
 | 
				
			||||
 * Enable this option for a leaner build of Marlin that removes all
 | 
				
			||||
 * workspace offsets, simplifying coordinate transformations, leveling, etc.
 | 
				
			||||
 *
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - M206 and M428 are disabled.
 | 
				
			||||
 *  - G92 will revert to its behavior from Marlin 1.0.
 | 
				
			||||
 */
 | 
				
			||||
//#define NO_WORKSPACE_OFFSETS
 | 
				
			||||
 | 
				
			||||
#endif // CONFIGURATION_ADV_H
 | 
				
			||||
					Loading…
					
					
				
		Reference in new issue